| <?php | |
| /** | |
| * This file contains schema declarations for all configuration variables | |
| * known to MediaWiki core. | |
| * | |
| * @file | |
| * @ingroup Config | |
| */ | |
| // phpcs:disable Generic.NamingConventions.UpperCaseConstantName.ClassConstantNotUpperCase | |
| // phpcs:disable Generic.Files.LineLength.TooLong | |
| namespace MediaWiki; | |
| use DateTime; | |
| use DateTimeZone; | |
| use Generator; | |
| use InvalidArgumentException; | |
| use LocalisationCache; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\CheckBlocksSecondaryAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\EmailNotificationSecondaryAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\LocalPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\PasswordAuthenticationRequest; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\ResetPasswordSecondaryAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\TemporaryPasswordAuthenticationRequest; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\TemporaryPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Auth\ThrottlePreAuthenticationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Config\ConfigException; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\CssContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\FallbackContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\JavaScriptContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\JsonContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\TextContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\VueContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Content\WikitextContentHandler; | |
| use MediaWiki\Deferred\SiteStatsUpdate; | |
| use MediaWiki\FileRepo\LocalRepo; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\JobQueueDB; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\AssembleUploadChunksJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\CategoryCountUpdateJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\CategoryMembershipChangeJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\CdnPurgeJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\DoubleRedirectJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\HTMLCacheUpdateJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\NullJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\ParsoidCachePrewarmJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\PublishStashedFileJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\RefreshLinksJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\RevertedTagUpdateJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\ThumbnailRenderJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\JobQueue\Jobs\UploadFromUrlJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Json\RsaJwtCodec; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\BlockLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\ContentModelLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\DeleteLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\ImportLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\InterwikiLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\LogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\MergeLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\MoveLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\PatrolLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\ProtectLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\RenameuserLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\RightsLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\TagLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Logging\UploadLogFormatter; | |
| use MediaWiki\Mail\EmaillingJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Page\DeleteLinksJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Page\DeletePageJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\Argon2Password; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\BcryptPassword; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\LayeredParameterizedPassword; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\MWOldPassword; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\MWSaltedPassword; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\PasswordPolicyChecks; | |
| use MediaWiki\Password\Pbkdf2PasswordUsingOpenSSL; | |
| use MediaWiki\Permissions\GrantsInfo; | |
| use MediaWiki\RCFeed\RedisPubSubFeedEngine; | |
| use MediaWiki\RCFeed\UDPRCFeedEngine; | |
| use MediaWiki\RecentChanges\RecentChangeNotifyJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\RecentChanges\RecentChangesUpdateJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\RenameUser\Job\RenameUserDerivedJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\RenameUser\Job\RenameUserTableJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Request\WebRequest; | |
| use MediaWiki\Session\SessionManager; | |
| use MediaWiki\Settings\Source\JsonSchemaTrait; | |
| use MediaWiki\Site\MediaWikiSite; | |
| use MediaWiki\Storage\SqlBlobStore; | |
| use MediaWiki\Title\NamespaceInfo; | |
| use MediaWiki\User\CentralId\LocalIdLookup; | |
| use MediaWiki\User\Registration\LocalUserRegistrationProvider; | |
| use MediaWiki\Watchlist\ActivityUpdateJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Watchlist\ClearUserWatchlistJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Watchlist\ClearWatchlistNotificationsJob; | |
| use MediaWiki\Watchlist\WatchlistExpiryJob; | |
| use ReflectionClass; | |
| use SqlBagOStuff; | |
| use UserEditCountInitJob; | |
| use UserGroupExpiryJob; | |
| use UserOptionsUpdateJob; | |
| use Wikimedia\EventRelayer\EventRelayerNull; | |
| use Wikimedia\ObjectCache\APCUBagOStuff; | |
| use Wikimedia\ObjectCache\EmptyBagOStuff; | |
| use Wikimedia\ObjectCache\HashBagOStuff; | |
| use Wikimedia\ObjectCache\MemcachedPeclBagOStuff; | |
| use Wikimedia\ObjectCache\MemcachedPhpBagOStuff; | |
| /** | |
| * This class contains schema declarations for all configuration variables | |
| * known to MediaWiki core. The schema definitions follow the JSON Schema | |
| * specification. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://json-schema.org/learn/getting-started-step-by-step.html | |
| * @see https://json-schema.org/understanding-json-schema/ | |
| * | |
| * The following JSON schema keys are used by MediaWiki: | |
| * - default: the configuration variable's default value. | |
| * - type: identifies the allowed value type or types. In addition to JSON Schema types, | |
| * PHPDoc style type definitions are supported for convenience. | |
| * Note that 'array' must not be used for associative arrays. | |
| * To avoid confusion, use 'list' for sequential arrays and 'map' for associative arrays | |
| * with uniform values. The 'object' type should be used for structures that have a known | |
| * set of meaningful properties, especially if each property may have a different kind | |
| * of value. | |
| * See {@link \MediaWiki\Settings\Source\JsonTypeHelper} for details. | |
| * | |
| * The following additional keys are used by MediaWiki: | |
| * - mergeStrategy: see the {@link \MediaWiki\Settings\Config\MergeStrategy}. | |
| * - dynamicDefault: Specified a callback that computes the effective default at runtime, based | |
| * on the value of other config variables or on the system environment. | |
| * See {@link \MediaWiki\Settings\Source\ReflectionSchemaSource} | |
| * and {@link \MediaWiki\Settings\DynamicDefaultValues} for details. | |
| * | |
| * @note After changing this file, run maintenance/generateConfigSchema.php to update | |
| * all the files derived from the information in MainConfigSchema. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| class MainConfigSchema { | |
| use JsonSchemaTrait; | |
| /** | |
| * Returns a generator for iterating over all config settings and their default values. | |
| * The primary use of this method is to import default values into local scope. | |
| * @code | |
| * foreach ( MainConfigSchema::listDefaultValues( 'wg' ) as $var => $value ) { | |
| * $$var = $value; | |
| * } | |
| * @endcode | |
| * | |
| * There should be no reason for application logic to do this. | |
| * | |
| * @note This method is relatively slow, it should not be used by | |
| * performance critical code. Application logic should generally | |
| * use ConfigSchema instead | |
| * | |
| * @param string $prefix A prefix to prepend to each setting name. | |
| * Typically, this will be "wg" when constructing global | |
| * variable names. | |
| * | |
| * @return Generator<string,mixed> $settingName => $defaultValue | |
| */ | |
| public static function listDefaultValues( string $prefix = '' ): Generator { | |
| $class = new ReflectionClass( self::class ); | |
| foreach ( $class->getReflectionConstants() as $const ) { | |
| if ( !$const->isPublic() ) { | |
| continue; | |
| } | |
| $value = $const->getValue(); | |
| if ( !is_array( $value ) ) { | |
| // Just in case we end up having some other kind of constant on this class. | |
| continue; | |
| } | |
| if ( isset( $value['obsolete'] ) ) { | |
| continue; | |
| } | |
| $name = $const->getName(); | |
| yield "$prefix$name" => self::getDefaultFromJsonSchema( $value ); | |
| } | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Returns the default value of the given config setting. | |
| * | |
| * @note This method is relatively slow, it should not be used by | |
| * performance critical code. Application logic should generally | |
| * use ConfigSchema instead | |
| * | |
| * @param string $name The config setting name. | |
| * | |
| * @return mixed The given config setting's default value, or null | |
| * if no default value is specified in the schema. | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultValue( string $name ) { | |
| $class = new ReflectionClass( self::class ); | |
| if ( !$class->hasConstant( $name ) ) { | |
| throw new InvalidArgumentException( "Unknown setting: $name" ); | |
| } | |
| $value = $class->getConstant( $name ); | |
| if ( !is_array( $value ) ) { | |
| // Might happen if we end up having other kinds of constants on this class. | |
| throw new InvalidArgumentException( "Unknown setting: $name" ); | |
| } | |
| return self::getDefaultFromJsonSchema( $value ); | |
| } | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| /** | |
| * Registry of factory functions to create config objects: | |
| * The 'main' key must be set, and the value should be a valid | |
| * callable. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const ConfigRegistry = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'main' => 'MediaWiki\\Config\\GlobalVarConfig::newInstance', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Name of the site. It must be changed in LocalSettings.php | |
| */ | |
| public const Sitename = [ | |
| 'default' => 'MediaWiki', | |
| ]; | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Server URLs and file paths | |
| /** @name Server URLs and file paths | |
| * | |
| * In this section, a "path" is usually a host-relative URL, i.e. a URL without | |
| * the host part, that starts with a slash. In most cases a full URL is also | |
| * acceptable. A "directory" is a local file path. | |
| * | |
| * In both paths and directories, trailing slashes should not be included. | |
| */ | |
| /** | |
| * URL of the server. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgServer = 'http://example.com'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * This must be set in LocalSettings.php. The MediaWiki installer does this | |
| * automatically since 1.18. | |
| * | |
| * If you want to use protocol-relative URLs on your wiki, set this to a | |
| * protocol-relative URL like '//example.com' and set $wgCanonicalServer | |
| * to a fully qualified URL. | |
| */ | |
| public const Server = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Canonical URL of the server, to use in IRC feeds and notification e-mails. | |
| * | |
| * Must be fully qualified, even if $wgServer is protocol-relative. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to $wgServer, expanded to a fully qualified http:// URL if needed. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.18 | |
| */ | |
| public const CanonicalServer = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Server name. This is automatically computed by parsing the bare | |
| * hostname out of $wgCanonicalServer. It should not be customized. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const ServerName = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When the wiki is running behind a proxy and this is set to true, assumes that the proxy | |
| * exposes the wiki on the standard ports (443 for https and 80 for http). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const AssumeProxiesUseDefaultProtocolPorts = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * For installations where the canonical server is HTTP but HTTPS is optionally | |
| * supported, you can specify a non-standard HTTPS port here. $wgServer should | |
| * be a protocol-relative URL. | |
| * | |
| * If HTTPS is always used, just specify the port number in $wgServer. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://phabricator.wikimedia.org/T67184 | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const HttpsPort = [ | |
| 'default' => 443, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is true, when an insecure HTTP request is received, always redirect | |
| * to HTTPS. This overrides and disables the preferhttps user preference, and it | |
| * overrides $wgSecureLogin. | |
| * | |
| * $wgServer may be either https or protocol-relative. If $wgServer starts with | |
| * "http://", an exception will be thrown. | |
| * | |
| * If a reverse proxy or CDN is used to forward requests from HTTPS to HTTP, | |
| * the request header "X-Forwarded-Proto: https" should be sent to suppress | |
| * the redirect. | |
| * | |
| * In addition to setting this to true, for optimal security, the web server | |
| * should also be configured to send Strict-Transport-Security response headers. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const ForceHTTPS = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The path we should point to. | |
| * | |
| * It might be a virtual path in case with use apache mod_rewrite for example. | |
| * | |
| * This *needs* to be set correctly. | |
| * | |
| * Other paths will be set to defaults based on it unless they are directly | |
| * set in LocalSettings.php | |
| */ | |
| public const ScriptPath = [ | |
| 'default' => '/wiki', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to support URLs like index.php/Page_title. | |
| * The effective default value is determined at runtime: | |
| * it will be enabled in environments where it is expected to be safe. | |
| * | |
| * Override this to false if $_SERVER['PATH_INFO'] contains unexpectedly | |
| * incorrect garbage, or to true if it is really correct. | |
| * | |
| * The default $wgArticlePath will be set based on this value at runtime, but if | |
| * you have customized it, having this incorrectly set to true can cause | |
| * redirect loops when "pretty URLs" are used. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.2.1 | |
| */ | |
| public const UsePathInfo = [ | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultUsePathInfo(): bool { | |
| // These often break when PHP is set up in CGI mode. | |
| // PATH_INFO *may* be correct if cgi.fix_pathinfo is set, but then again it may not; | |
| // lighttpd converts incoming path data to lowercase on systems | |
| // with case-insensitive filesystems, and there have been reports of | |
| // problems on Apache as well. | |
| return !str_contains( PHP_SAPI, 'cgi' ) && !str_contains( PHP_SAPI, 'apache2filter' ) && | |
| !str_contains( PHP_SAPI, 'isapi' ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path to index.php. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScriptPath}/index.php". | |
| */ | |
| public const Script = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultScript( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| return "$scriptPath/index.php"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path to load.php. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScriptPath}/load.php". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const LoadScript = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultLoadScript( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| return "$scriptPath/load.php"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path to the REST API. | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScriptPath}/rest.php" | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const RestPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultRestPath( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| return "$scriptPath/rest.php"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the skins directory. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgResourceBasePath}/skins". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const StylePath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ResourceBasePath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $resourceBasePath Value of ResourceBasePath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultStylePath( $resourceBasePath ): string { | |
| return "$resourceBasePath/skins"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the skins directory. Should not point to an external domain. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScriptPath}/skins". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalStylePath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultLocalStylePath( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| // Avoid ResourceBasePath here since that may point to a different domain (e.g. CDN) | |
| return "$scriptPath/skins"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the extensions directory. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgResourceBasePath}/extensions". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionAssetsPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ResourceBasePath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $resourceBasePath Value of ResourceBasePath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultExtensionAssetsPath( $resourceBasePath ): string { | |
| return "$resourceBasePath/extensions"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Extensions directory in the file system. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$IP}/extensions" in Setup.php | |
| * | |
| * @note This configuration variable is used to locate extensions while loading settings. | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Skins directory in the file system. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$IP}/skins" in Setup.php. | |
| * | |
| * @note This configuration variable is used to locate skins while loading settings. | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const StyleDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path for primary article page views. This path should contain $1, | |
| * which is replaced by the article title. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScript}/$1" or "{$wgScript}?title=$1", | |
| * depending on $wgUsePathInfo. | |
| */ | |
| public const ArticlePath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'Script', 'UsePathInfo' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param string $script Value of Script | |
| * @param mixed $usePathInfo Value of UsePathInfo | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultArticlePath( string $script, $usePathInfo ): string { | |
| if ( $usePathInfo ) { | |
| return "$script/$1"; | |
| } | |
| return "$script?title=$1"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path to $wgUploadDirectory. Shortcut for $wgLocalFileRepo['url']. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgScriptPath}/images". | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultUploadPath( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| return "$scriptPath/images"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The base path for img_auth.php. This is used to interpret the request URL | |
| * for requests to img_auth.php that do not match the base upload path. If | |
| * false, "{$wgScriptPath}/img_auth.php" is used. | |
| * | |
| * Normally, requests to img_auth.php have a REQUEST_URI which matches | |
| * $wgUploadPath, and in that case, setting this should not be necessary. | |
| * This variable is used in case img_auth.php is accessed via a different path | |
| * than $wgUploadPath. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const ImgAuthPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The base path for thumb_handler.php. This is used to interpret the request URL | |
| * for requests to thumb_handler.php that do not match the base upload path. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The filesystem path of the images directory. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$IP}/images" in Setup.php. | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => '?string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Directory where the cached page will be saved. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgUploadDirectory}/cache". | |
| */ | |
| public const FileCacheDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'UploadDirectory' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $uploadDirectory Value of UploadDirectory | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultFileCacheDirectory( $uploadDirectory ): string { | |
| return "$uploadDirectory/cache"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the wiki logo. The logo size should be 135x135 pixels. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "$wgResourceBasePath/resources/assets/change-your-logo.svg". | |
| * Developers should retrieve this logo (and other variants) using | |
| * the static function MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\SkinModule::getAvailableLogos | |
| * Ignored if $wgLogos is set. | |
| */ | |
| public const Logo = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ResourceBasePath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $resourceBasePath Value of ResourceBasePath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultLogo( $resourceBasePath ): string { | |
| return "$resourceBasePath/resources/assets/change-your-logo.svg"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Specification for different versions of the wiki logo. | |
| * | |
| * This is an array which should have the following k/v pairs: | |
| * All path values can be either absolute or relative URIs | |
| * | |
| * The `1x` key is a path to the 1x version of square logo (should be 135x135 pixels) | |
| * The `1.5x` key is a path to the 1.5x version of square logo | |
| * The `2x` key is a path to the 2x version of square logo | |
| * The `svg` key is a path to the svg version of square logo | |
| * The `icon` key is a path to the version of the logo without wordmark and tagline | |
| * The `wordmark` key may be null or an array with the following fields | |
| * - `src` path to wordmark version | |
| * - `1x` path to svg wordmark version (if you want to | |
| * support browsers with SVG support with an SVG logo) | |
| * - `width` width of the logo in pixels | |
| * - `height` height of the logo in pixels | |
| * The `tagline` key may be null or array with the following fields | |
| * - `src` path to tagline image | |
| * - `width` width of the tagline in pixels | |
| * - `height` height of the tagline in pixels | |
| * | |
| * | |
| * @par Example: | |
| * @code | |
| * $wgLogos = [ | |
| * '1x' => 'path/to/1x_version.png', | |
| * '1.5x' => 'path/to/1.5x_version.png', | |
| * '2x' => 'path/to/2x_version.png', | |
| * 'svg' => 'path/to/svg_version.svg', | |
| * 'icon' => 'path/to/icon.png', | |
| * 'wordmark' => [ | |
| * 'src' => 'path/to/wordmark_version.png', | |
| * '1x' => 'path/to/wordmark_version.svg', | |
| * 'width' => 135, | |
| * 'height' => 20, | |
| * ], | |
| * 'tagline' => [ | |
| * 'src' => 'path/to/tagline_version.png', | |
| * 'width' => 135, | |
| * 'height' => 15, | |
| * ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * @endcode | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to [ "1x" => $wgLogo ], | |
| * or [ "1x" => "$wgResourceBasePath/resources/assets/change-your-logo.svg" ] if $wgLogo is not set. | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const Logos = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'map|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the icon. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.6 | |
| */ | |
| public const Favicon = [ | |
| 'default' => '/favicon.ico', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The URL path of the icon for iPhone and iPod Touch web app bookmarks. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to no icon. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.12 | |
| */ | |
| public const AppleTouchIcon = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Value for the referrer policy meta tag. | |
| * | |
| * One or more of the values defined in the Referrer Policy specification: | |
| * https://w3c.github.io/webappsec-referrer-policy/ | |
| * ('no-referrer', 'no-referrer-when-downgrade', 'same-origin', | |
| * 'origin', 'strict-origin', 'origin-when-cross-origin', | |
| * 'strict-origin-when-cross-origin', or 'unsafe-url') | |
| * Setting it to false prevents the meta tag from being output | |
| * (which results in falling back to the Referrer-Policy header, | |
| * or 'no-referrer-when-downgrade' if that's not set either.) | |
| * Setting it to an array (supported since 1.31) will create a meta tag for | |
| * each value, in the reverse of the order (meaning that the first array element | |
| * will be the default and the others used as fallbacks for browsers which do not | |
| * understand it). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const ReferrerPolicy = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'list|string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The local filesystem path to a temporary directory. This must not be web-accessible. | |
| * | |
| * When this setting is set to false, its value will automatically be decided | |
| * through the first call to wfTempDir(). See that method's implementation for | |
| * the actual detection logic. | |
| * | |
| * To find the temporary path for the current wiki, developers must not use | |
| * this variable directly. Use the global function wfTempDir() instead. | |
| * | |
| * The temporary directory is expected to be shared with other applications, | |
| * including other MediaWiki instances (which might not run the same version | |
| * or configuration). When storing files here, take care to avoid conflicts | |
| * with other instances of MediaWiki. For example, when caching the result | |
| * of a computation, the file name should incorporate the input of the | |
| * computation so that it cannot be confused for the result of a similar | |
| * computation by another MediaWiki instance. | |
| * | |
| * @see \wfTempDir() | |
| * @note Default changed to false in MediaWiki 1.20. | |
| */ | |
| public const TmpDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set, this server URL is prepended to $wgUploadPath in the default | |
| * value of $wgLocalFileRepo['url']. | |
| * | |
| * It is meant for controlling web access to $wgUploadPath via an alternative | |
| * domain name, instead of $wgServer, such as may be needed if your images | |
| * are uploaded to a third-party file storage service. | |
| * | |
| * For other customizations, set $wgLocalFileRepo['url'] directly instead. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.4 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadBaseUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * To enable remote on-demand scaling, set this to the thumbnail base URL. | |
| * | |
| * Full thumbnail URL will be like $wgUploadStashScalerBaseUrl/e/e6/Foo.jpg/123px-Foo.jpg | |
| * where 'e6' are the first two characters of the MD5 hash of the file name. | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.36 Use thumbProxyUrl in $wgLocalFileRepo | |
| * | |
| * If $wgUploadStashScalerBaseUrl and thumbProxyUrl are both false, thumbs are | |
| * rendered locally as needed. | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadStashScalerBaseUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.36 Use thumbProxyUrl in $wgLocalFileRepo', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * To set 'pretty' URL paths for actions other than | |
| * plain page views, add to this array. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Set pretty URL for the edit action: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * 'edit' => "$wgScriptPath/edit/$1" | |
| * ``` | |
| * There must be an appropriate script or rewrite rule in place to handle these URLs. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const ActionPaths = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When enabled, the domain root will show the wiki's main page, | |
| * instead of redirecting to the main page. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const MainPageIsDomainRoot = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of server URLs and file paths | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Files and file uploads | |
| /** @name Files and file uploads */ | |
| /** | |
| * Allow users to upload files. | |
| * | |
| * Use $wgLocalFileRepo to control how and where uploads are stored. | |
| * Disabled by default as for security reasons. | |
| * See <https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Configuring_file_uploads>. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableUploads = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum age of temporary (incomplete) uploaded files | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadStashMaxAge = [ | |
| 'default' => 6 * 3600, // 6 hours | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable deferred upload tasks that use the job queue. | |
| * | |
| * Only enable this if job runners are set up for both the | |
| * 'AssembleUploadChunks','PublishStashedFile' and 'UploadFromUrl' job types. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableAsyncUploads = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable the async processing of upload by url in Special:Upload. | |
| * | |
| * Only works if EnableAsyncUploads is also enabled | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableAsyncUploadsByURL = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * To disable file delete/restore temporarily | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadMaintenance = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional characters that are not allowed in filenames. They are replaced with '-' when | |
| * uploading. Like $wgLegalTitleChars, this is a regexp character class. | |
| * | |
| * Slashes and backslashes are disallowed regardless of this setting, but included here for | |
| * completeness. | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.41; no longer customizable | |
| */ | |
| public const IllegalFileChars = [ | |
| 'default' => ':\\/\\\\', | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.41; no longer customizable', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Where to move deleted files to. Shortcut for $wgLocalFileRepo['deletedDir']. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "{$wgUploadDirectory}/deleted". | |
| */ | |
| public const DeletedDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'UploadDirectory' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $uploadDirectory Value of UploadDirectory | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultDeletedDirectory( $uploadDirectory ): string { | |
| return "$uploadDirectory/deleted"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true if you use img_auth and want the user to see details on why access failed. | |
| */ | |
| public const ImgAuthDetails = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map of relative URL directories to match to internal mwstore:// base storage paths. | |
| * | |
| * For img_auth.php requests, everything after "img_auth.php/" is checked to see | |
| * if starts with any of the prefixes defined here. The prefixes should not overlap. | |
| * The prefix that matches has a corresponding storage path, which the rest of the URL | |
| * is assumed to be relative to. The file at that path (or a 404) is send to the client. | |
| * | |
| * Example: | |
| * $wgImgAuthUrlPathMap['/timeline/'] = 'mwstore://local-fs/timeline-render/'; | |
| * The above maps ".../img_auth.php/timeline/X" to "mwstore://local-fs/timeline-render/". | |
| * The name "local-fs" should correspond by name to an entry in $wgFileBackends. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::FileBackends | |
| */ | |
| public const ImgAuthUrlPathMap = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * File repository structures | |
| * | |
| * $wgLocalFileRepo is a single repository structure, and $wgForeignFileRepos is | |
| * an array of such structures. Each repository structure is an associative | |
| * array of properties configuring the repository. | |
| * | |
| * Properties required for all repos: | |
| * - class The class name for the repository. May come from the core or an extension. | |
| * The core repository classes are FileRepo, LocalRepo, ForeignDBRepo. | |
| * | |
| * - name A unique name for the repository (but $wgLocalFileRepo should be 'local'). | |
| * The name should consist of alpha-numeric characters. | |
| * | |
| * Optional common properties: | |
| * - backend A file backend name (see $wgFileBackends). If not specified, or | |
| * if the name is not present in $wgFileBackends, an FSFileBackend | |
| * will automatically be configured. | |
| * - lockManager If a file backend is automatically configured, this will be lock | |
| * manager name used. A lock manager named in $wgLockManagers, or one of | |
| * the default lock managers "fsLockManager" or "nullLockManager". Default | |
| * "fsLockManager". | |
| * - favicon URL to a favicon. This is exposed via FileRepo::getInfo and | |
| * ApiQueryFileRepoInfo. Originally for use by MediaViewer (T77093). | |
| * | |
| * For most core repos: | |
| * - zones Associative array of zone names that each map to an array with: | |
| * container : backend container name the zone is in | |
| * directory : root path within container for the zone | |
| * url : base URL to the root of the zone | |
| * urlsByExt : map of file extension types to base URLs | |
| * (useful for using a different cache for videos) | |
| * Zones default to using "<repo name>-<zone name>" as the container name | |
| * and default to using the container root as the zone's root directory. | |
| * Nesting of zone locations within other zones should be avoided. | |
| * - url Public zone URL. The 'zones' settings take precedence. | |
| * - hashLevels The number of directory levels for hash-based division of files. | |
| * | |
| * Set this to 0 if you do not want MediaWiki to divide your images | |
| * directory into many subdirectories. | |
| * | |
| * It is recommended to leave this enabled. In previous versions of | |
| * MediaWiki, some users set this to false to allow images to be added to | |
| * the wiki by copying them into $wgUploadDirectory and then running | |
| * maintenance/rebuildImages.php to register them in the database. | |
| * This is no longer supported, use maintenance/importImages.php instead. | |
| * | |
| * Default: 2. | |
| * - deletedHashLevels | |
| * Optional 'hashLevels' override for the 'deleted' zone. | |
| * - thumbScriptUrl The URL for thumb.php (optional, not recommended) | |
| * - transformVia404 Whether to skip media file transformation on parse and rely on a 404 | |
| * handler instead. | |
| * - thumbProxyUrl Optional. URL of where to proxy thumb.php requests to. This is | |
| * also used internally for remote thumbnailing of upload stash files. | |
| * Example: http://127.0.0.1:8888/wiki/dev/thumb/ | |
| * - thumbProxySecret Optional value of the X-Swift-Secret header to use in requests to | |
| * thumbProxyUrl | |
| * - disableLocalTransform | |
| * If present and true, local image scaling will be disabled. If attempted, | |
| * it will show an error to the user and log an error message. To avoid an | |
| * error, thumbProxyUrl must be set, as well as either transformVia404 | |
| * (preferred) or thumbScriptUrl. | |
| * - initialCapital Equivalent to $wgCapitalLinks (or $wgCapitalLinkOverrides[NS_FILE], | |
| * determines whether filenames implicitly start with a capital letter. | |
| * The current implementation may give incorrect description page links | |
| * when the local $wgCapitalLinks and initialCapital are mismatched. | |
| * - pathDisclosureProtection | |
| * May be 'paranoid' to remove all parameters from error messages, 'none' to | |
| * leave the paths in unchanged, or 'simple' to replace paths with | |
| * placeholders. Default for LocalRepo is 'simple'. | |
| * - fileMode This allows wikis to set the file mode when uploading/moving files. Default | |
| * is 0644. | |
| * - directory The local filesystem directory where public files are stored. Not used for | |
| * some remote repos. | |
| * - deletedDir The local filesystem directory where public files are moved to (from | |
| * 'directory') when they are deleted, at which points they become private. | |
| * Defaults to false, which disables the file deletion feature. | |
| * - thumbDir The base thumbnail directory. Defaults to "<directory>/thumb". | |
| * - thumbUrl The base thumbnail URL. Defaults to "<url>/thumb". | |
| * - isPrivate Set this if measures should always be taken to keep the files private. | |
| * One should not trust this to assure that the files are not web readable; | |
| * the server configuration should be done manually depending on the backend. | |
| * - useJsonMetadata Whether handler metadata should be stored in JSON format. Default: true. | |
| * - useSplitMetadata Whether handler metadata should be split up and stored in the text table. | |
| * Default: false. | |
| * - splitMetadataThreshold | |
| * If the media handler opts in, large metadata items will be split into a | |
| * separate blob in the database if the item is larger than this threshold. | |
| * Default: 1000 | |
| * - updateCompatibleMetadata | |
| * When true, image metadata will be upgraded by reloading it from the original | |
| * file, if the handler indicates that it is out of date. | |
| * | |
| * By default, when purging a file or otherwise refreshing file metadata, it | |
| * is only reloaded when the metadata is invalid. Valid data originally loaded | |
| * by a current or older compatible version is left unchanged. Enable this | |
| * to also reload and upgrade metadata that was stored by an older compatible | |
| * version. See also MediaHandler::isMetadataValid, and RefreshImageMetadata. | |
| * | |
| * Default: false. | |
| * | |
| * - reserializeMetadata | |
| * If true, image metadata will be automatically rewritten to the database | |
| * if its serialization format is out of date. Default: false | |
| * | |
| * These settings describe a foreign MediaWiki installation. They are optional, and will be ignored | |
| * for local repositories: | |
| * - descBaseUrl URL of image description pages, e.g. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/File: | |
| * - scriptDirUrl URL of the MediaWiki installation, equivalent to $wgScriptPath, e.g. | |
| * https://en.wikipedia.org/w | |
| * - articleUrl Equivalent to $wgArticlePath, e.g. https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/$1 | |
| * - fetchDescription Fetch the text of the remote file description page and display them | |
| * on the local wiki. | |
| * - abbrvThreshold File names over this size will use the short form of thumbnail names. | |
| * Short thumbnail names only have the width, parameters, and the extension. | |
| * | |
| * ForeignDBRepo: | |
| * - dbType, dbServer, dbUser, dbPassword, dbName, dbFlags | |
| * equivalent to the corresponding member of $wgDBservers | |
| * - tablePrefix Table prefix, the foreign wiki's $wgDBprefix | |
| * - hasSharedCache Set to true if the foreign wiki's $wgMainCacheType is identical to, | |
| * and accessible from, this wiki. | |
| * | |
| * ForeignAPIRepo: | |
| * - apibase Use for the foreign API's URL | |
| * - apiThumbCacheExpiry How long to locally cache thumbs for | |
| * | |
| * If you set $wgForeignFileRepos to an array of repository structures, those will | |
| * be searched after the local file repo. | |
| * Otherwise, you will only have access to local media files. | |
| * | |
| * @see SetupDynamicConfig.php for expansion of below initial values. | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalFileRepo = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'class' => LocalRepo::class, | |
| 'name' => 'local', | |
| 'directory' => null, // $wgUploadDirectory | |
| 'scriptDirUrl' => null, // $wgScriptPath | |
| 'favicon' => null, // $wgFavicon | |
| 'url' => null, // $wgUploadBaseUrl . $wgUploadPath | |
| 'hashLevels' => null, // $wgHashedUploadDirectory | |
| 'thumbScriptUrl' => null, // $wgThumbnailScriptPath | |
| 'transformVia404' => null, // $wgGenerateThumbnailOnParse | |
| 'deletedDir' => null, // $wgDeletedDirectory | |
| 'deletedHashLevels' => null, // $wgHashedUploadDirectory | |
| 'updateCompatibleMetadata' => null, // $wgUpdateCompatibleMetadata | |
| 'reserializeMetadata' => null, // $wgUpdateCompatibleMetadata | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable the use of files from one or more other wikis. | |
| * | |
| * If you operate multiple wikis, you can declare a shared upload path here. | |
| * Uploads to the local wiki will NOT be stored here - See $wgLocalFileRepo | |
| * and $wgUploadDirectory for that. | |
| * | |
| * When performing file lookups (e.g. via `[[File:..]]` syntax), the wiki will | |
| * only consider the foreign repository if no file of the given name is found | |
| * in the local repository ($wgLocalFileRepo). | |
| * | |
| * If you set $wgUseInstantCommons to true, this automatically includes | |
| * an entry for Wikimedia Commons. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.11 | |
| * @see self::LocalFileRepo | |
| */ | |
| public const ForeignFileRepos = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use Wikimedia Commons as a foreign file repository. | |
| * | |
| * This is a shortcut for adding an entry to $wgForeignFileRepos | |
| * for https://commons.wikimedia.org, using ForeignAPIRepo with the | |
| * default settings. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseInstantCommons = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for adding an entry to $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Uses the following variables: | |
| * | |
| * - directory: $wgSharedUploadDirectory. | |
| * - url: $wgSharedUploadPath. | |
| * - hashLevels: Based on $wgHashedSharedUploadDirectory. | |
| * - thumbScriptUrl: $wgSharedThumbnailScriptPath. | |
| * - transformVia404: Based on $wgGenerateThumbnailOnParse. | |
| * - descBaseUrl: $wgRepositoryBaseUrl. | |
| * - fetchDescription: $wgFetchCommonsDescriptions. | |
| * | |
| * If $wgSharedUploadDBname is set, it uses the ForeignDBRepo | |
| * class, with also the following variables: | |
| * | |
| * - dbName: $wgSharedUploadDBname. | |
| * - dbType: $wgDBtype. | |
| * - dbServer: $wgDBserver. | |
| * - dbUser: $wgDBuser. | |
| * - dbPassword: $wgDBpassword. | |
| * - dbFlags: Based on $wgDebugDumpSql. | |
| * - tablePrefix: $wgSharedUploadDBprefix, | |
| * - hasSharedCache: $wgCacheSharedUploads. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseSharedUploads = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'directory' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedUploadDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'url' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedUploadPath = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'hashLevels' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const HashedSharedUploadDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'descBaseUrl' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const RepositoryBaseUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => 'https://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/File:', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'fetchDescription' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const FetchCommonsDescriptions = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the ForeignDBRepo 'dbName' setting in $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Set this to false if the uploads do not come from a wiki. | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.4 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedUploadDBname = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the ForeignDBRepo 'tablePrefix' setting in $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedUploadDBprefix = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the ForeignDBRepo 'hasSharedCache' setting in $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const CacheSharedUploads = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of foreign file repo names (set in $wgForeignFileRepos above) that | |
| * are allowable upload targets. These wikis must have some method of | |
| * authentication (i.e. CentralAuth), and be CORS-enabled for this wiki. | |
| * | |
| * The string 'local' signifies the default local file repository. | |
| * | |
| * Example: | |
| * $wgForeignUploadTargets = [ 'shared' ]; | |
| */ | |
| public const ForeignUploadTargets = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'local', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for file uploads using the embeddable upload dialog | |
| * (https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Upload_dialog). | |
| * | |
| * This applies also to foreign uploads to this wiki (the configuration is loaded by remote | |
| * wikis using the action=query&meta=siteinfo API). | |
| * | |
| * See below for documentation of each property. None of the properties may be omitted. | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadDialog = [ | |
| 'default' => | |
| [ | |
| 'fields' => | |
| [ | |
| 'description' => true, | |
| 'date' => false, | |
| 'categories' => false, | |
| ], | |
| 'licensemessages' => | |
| [ | |
| 'local' => 'generic-local', | |
| 'foreign' => 'generic-foreign', | |
| ], | |
| 'comment' => | |
| [ | |
| 'local' => '', | |
| 'foreign' => '', | |
| ], | |
| 'format' => | |
| [ | |
| 'filepage' => '$DESCRIPTION', | |
| 'description' => '$TEXT', | |
| 'ownwork' => '', | |
| 'license' => '', | |
| 'uncategorized' => '', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * File backend structure configuration. | |
| * | |
| * This is an array of file backend configuration arrays. | |
| * Each backend configuration has the following parameters: | |
| * - name : A unique name for the backend | |
| * - class : The file backend class to use | |
| * - wikiId : A unique string that identifies the wiki (container prefix) | |
| * - lockManager : The name of a lock manager (see $wgLockManagers) [optional] | |
| * | |
| * See FileBackend::__construct() for more details. | |
| * Additional parameters are specific to the file backend class used. | |
| * These settings should be global to all wikis when possible. | |
| * | |
| * FileBackendMultiWrite::__construct() is augmented with a 'template' option that | |
| * can be used in any of the values of the 'backends' array. Its value is the name of | |
| * another backend in $wgFileBackends. When set, it pre-fills the array with all of the | |
| * configuration of the named backend. Explicitly set values in the array take precedence. | |
| * | |
| * There are two particularly important aspects about each backend: | |
| * - a) Whether it is fully qualified or wiki-relative. | |
| * By default, the paths of files are relative to the current wiki, | |
| * which works via prefixing them with the current wiki ID when accessed. | |
| * Setting 'domainId' forces the backend to be fully qualified by prefixing | |
| * all paths with the specified value instead. This can be useful if | |
| * multiple wikis need to share the same data. Note that 'name' is *not* | |
| * part of any prefix and thus should not be relied upon for namespacing. | |
| * - b) Whether it is only defined for some wikis or is defined on all | |
| * wikis in the wiki farm. Defining a backend globally is useful | |
| * if multiple wikis need to share the same data. | |
| * | |
| * One should be aware of these aspects when configuring a backend for use with | |
| * any basic feature or plugin. For example, suppose an extension stores data for | |
| * different wikis in different directories and sometimes needs to access data from | |
| * a foreign wiki's directory in order to render a page on given wiki. The extension | |
| * would need a fully qualified backend that is defined on all wikis in the wiki farm. | |
| */ | |
| public const FileBackends = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of lock manager backend configurations. | |
| * | |
| * Each backend configuration has the following parameters: | |
| * - name : A unique name for the lock manager | |
| * - class : The lock manager class to use | |
| * | |
| * See LockManager::__construct() for more details. | |
| * Additional parameters are specific to the lock manager class used. | |
| * These settings should be global to all wikis. | |
| * | |
| * Minimal example: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgLockManagers[] = [ | |
| * 'name' => 'locky-mc-lock-face', | |
| * 'class' => 'MemcLockManager', | |
| * 'lockServers' => [ | |
| * '127.0.0.1:11211', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const LockManagers = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to show Exif data. | |
| * The effective default value is determined at runtime: | |
| * enabled if PHP's EXIF extension module is loaded. | |
| * | |
| * Requires PHP's Exif extension: https://www.php.net/manual/en/ref.exif.php | |
| * | |
| * @note FOR WINDOWS USERS: | |
| * To enable Exif functions, add the following line to the "Windows | |
| * extensions" section of php.ini: | |
| * | |
| * ```{.ini} | |
| * extension=extensions/php_exif.dll | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowEXIF = [ | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'callback' => [ self::class, 'getDefaultShowEXIF' ] ], | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultShowEXIF(): bool { | |
| return function_exists( 'exif_read_data' ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'updateCompatibleMetadata' setting of $wgLocalFileRepo. | |
| */ | |
| public const UpdateCompatibleMetadata = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow for upload to be copied from an URL. | |
| * | |
| * The timeout for copy uploads is set by $wgCopyUploadTimeout. | |
| * You have to assign the user right 'upload_by_url' to a user group, to use this. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowCopyUploads = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A list of domains copy uploads can come from | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const CopyUploadsDomains = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable copy uploads from Special:Upload. $wgAllowCopyUploads must also be | |
| * true. If $wgAllowCopyUploads is true, but this is false, you will only be | |
| * able to perform copy uploads from the API or extensions (e.g. UploadWizard). | |
| */ | |
| public const CopyUploadsFromSpecialUpload = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Proxy to use for copy upload requests. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const CopyUploadProxy = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Different timeout for upload by url | |
| * This could be useful since when fetching large files, you may want a | |
| * timeout longer than the default $wgHTTPTimeout. False means fallback | |
| * to default. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const CopyUploadTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, the value of $wgCopyUploadsDomains will be merged with the | |
| * contents of MediaWiki:Copyupload-allowed-domains. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const CopyUploadAllowOnWikiDomainConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Max size for uploads, in bytes. | |
| * | |
| * If not set to an array, applies to all uploads. If set to an array, per upload | |
| * type maximums can be set, using the file and url keys. If the `*` key is set | |
| * this value will be used as maximum for non-specified types. | |
| * | |
| * The below example would set the maximum for all uploads to 250 KiB except, | |
| * for upload-by-url, which would have a maximum of 500 KiB. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgMaxUploadSize = [ | |
| * '*' => 250 * 1024, | |
| * 'url' => 500 * 1024, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * Default: 100 MiB. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxUploadSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 1024 * 1024 * 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Minimum upload chunk size, in bytes. | |
| * | |
| * When using chunked upload, non-final chunks smaller than this will be rejected. | |
| * | |
| * Note that this may be further reduced by the `upload_max_filesize` and | |
| * `post_max_size` PHP settings. Use ApiUpload::getMinUploadChunkSize to | |
| * get the effective minimum chunk size used by MediaWiki. | |
| * | |
| * Default: 1 KiB. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| * @see \ApiUpload::getMinUploadChunkSize | |
| */ | |
| public const MinUploadChunkSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 1024, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Point the upload navigation link to an external URL | |
| * Useful if you want to use a shared repository by default | |
| * without disabling local uploads (use $wgEnableUploads = false for that). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgUploadNavigationUrl = 'https://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/Special:Upload'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadNavigationUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Point the upload link for missing files to an external URL, as with | |
| * $wgUploadNavigationUrl. The URL will get "(?|&)wpDestFile=<filename>" | |
| * appended to it as appropriate. | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadMissingFileUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Give a path here to use thumb.php for thumbnail generation on client | |
| * request, instead of generating them on render and outputting a static URL. | |
| * | |
| * This is necessary if some of your apache servers don't have read/write | |
| * access to the thumbnail path. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgThumbnailScriptPath = "{$wgScriptPath}/thumb.php"; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailScriptPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for the 'thumbScriptUrl' setting of $wgForeignFileRepos. | |
| * | |
| * Only used if $wgUseSharedUploads is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.3 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedThumbnailScriptPath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for setting `hashLevels=2` and `deletedHashLevels=3` in $wgLocalFileRepo. | |
| * | |
| * @note Only used if $wgLocalFileRepo is not set. | |
| */ | |
| public const HashedUploadDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Controls whether thumb.php and img_auth.php send CSP headers | |
| * | |
| * Note: This does not control general uploads. There is a .htaccess | |
| * in the images directory which will add a CSP header in some web server | |
| * configurations | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const CSPUploadEntryPoint = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This is the list of preferred extensions for uploading files. Uploading files | |
| * with extensions not in this list will trigger a warning. | |
| * | |
| * @warning If you add any OpenOffice or Microsoft Office file formats here, | |
| * such as odt or doc, and untrusted users are allowed to upload files, then | |
| * your wiki will be vulnerable to cross-site request forgery (CSRF). | |
| */ | |
| public const FileExtensions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'png', 'gif', 'jpg', 'jpeg', 'webp', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Files with these extensions will never be allowed as uploads. | |
| * | |
| * An array of file extensions to prevent being uploaded. You should | |
| * append to this array if you want to prevent additional file extensions. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37; previously $wgFileBlacklist | |
| */ | |
| public const ProhibitedFileExtensions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| # HTML may contain cookie-stealing JavaScript and web bugs | |
| 'html', 'htm', 'js', 'jsb', 'mhtml', 'mht', 'xhtml', 'xht', | |
| # PHP scripts may execute arbitrary code on the server | |
| 'php', 'phtml', 'php3', 'php4', 'php5', 'phps', 'phar', | |
| # Other types that may be interpreted by some servers | |
| 'shtml', 'jhtml', 'pl', 'py', 'cgi', | |
| # May contain harmful executables for Windows victims | |
| 'exe', 'scr', 'dll', 'msi', 'vbs', 'bat', 'com', 'pif', 'cmd', 'vxd', 'cpl', | |
| # T341565 | |
| 'xml', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Files with these MIME types will never be allowed as uploads | |
| * if $wgVerifyMimeType is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37; previously $wgMimeTypeBlacklist | |
| */ | |
| public const MimeTypeExclusions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| # HTML may contain cookie-stealing JavaScript and web bugs | |
| 'text/html', | |
| # Similarly with JavaScript itself | |
| 'application/javascript', 'text/javascript', 'text/x-javascript', 'application/x-shellscript', | |
| # PHP scripts may execute arbitrary code on the server | |
| 'application/x-php', 'text/x-php', | |
| # Other types that may be interpreted by some servers | |
| 'text/x-python', 'text/x-perl', 'text/x-bash', 'text/x-sh', 'text/x-csh', | |
| # Client-side hazards on Internet Explorer | |
| 'text/scriptlet', 'application/x-msdownload', | |
| # Windows metafile, client-side vulnerability on some systems | |
| 'application/x-msmetafile', | |
| # Files that look like java files | |
| 'application/java', | |
| # XML files generally - T341565 | |
| 'application/xml', 'text/xml', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This is a flag to determine whether or not to check file extensions on upload. | |
| * | |
| * @warning Setting this to false is insecure for public wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const CheckFileExtensions = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is turned off, users may override the warning for files not covered | |
| * by $wgFileExtensions. | |
| * | |
| * @warning Setting this to false is insecure for public wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const StrictFileExtensions = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Setting this to true will disable the upload system's checks for HTML/JavaScript. | |
| * | |
| * @warning THIS IS VERY DANGEROUS on a publicly editable site, so USE | |
| * $wgGroupPermissions TO RESTRICT UPLOADING to only those that you trust | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableUploadScriptChecks = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Warn if uploaded files are larger than this (in bytes), or false to disable | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadSizeWarning = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * list of trusted media-types and MIME types. | |
| * | |
| * Use the MEDIATYPE_xxx constants to represent media types. | |
| * This list is used by File::isSafeFile | |
| * | |
| * Types not listed here will have a warning about unsafe content | |
| * displayed on the images description page. It would also be possible | |
| * to use this for further restrictions, like disabling direct | |
| * [[media:...]] links for non-trusted formats. | |
| */ | |
| public const TrustedMediaFormats = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| MEDIATYPE_BITMAP, // all bitmap formats | |
| MEDIATYPE_AUDIO, // all audio formats | |
| MEDIATYPE_VIDEO, // all plain video formats | |
| "image/svg+xml", // svg (only needed if inline rendering of svg is not supported) | |
| "application/pdf", // PDF files | |
| # "application/x-shockwave-flash", //flash/shockwave movie | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Plugins for media file type handling. | |
| * | |
| * Each entry in the array maps a MIME type to a class name | |
| * | |
| * Core media handlers are listed in MediaHandlerFactory, | |
| * and extensions should use extension.json. | |
| */ | |
| public const MediaHandlers = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Toggles native image lazy loading, via the "loading" attribute. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const NativeImageLazyLoading = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Media handler overrides for parser tests (they don't need to generate actual | |
| * thumbnails, so a mock will do) | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserTestMediaHandlers = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'image/jpeg' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/png' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/gif' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/tiff' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/webp' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/x-ms-bmp' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/x-bmp' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/x-xcf' => 'MockBitmapHandler', | |
| 'image/svg+xml' => 'MockSvgHandler', | |
| 'image/vnd.djvu' => 'MockDjVuHandler', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable server-side image thumbnailing. If false, images will | |
| * always be sent to the client in full resolution, with appropriate width= and | |
| * height= attributes on the <img> tag for the client to do its own scaling. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseImageResize = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Resizing can be done using PHP's internal image libraries or using | |
| * ImageMagick or another third-party converter, e.g. GraphicMagick. | |
| * | |
| * These support more file formats than PHP, which only supports PNG, | |
| * GIF, JPG, XBM and WBMP. | |
| * | |
| * Use Image Magick instead of PHP builtin functions. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseImageMagick = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The convert command shipped with ImageMagick | |
| */ | |
| public const ImageMagickConvertCommand = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/convert', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of max pixel areas for interlacing per MIME type | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxInterlacingAreas = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sharpening parameter to ImageMagick | |
| */ | |
| public const SharpenParameter = [ | |
| 'default' => '0x0.4', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Reduction in linear dimensions below which sharpening will be enabled | |
| */ | |
| public const SharpenReductionThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => 0.85, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Temporary directory used for ImageMagick. The directory must exist. Leave | |
| * this set to false to let ImageMagick decide for itself. | |
| */ | |
| public const ImageMagickTempDir = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use another resizing converter, e.g. GraphicMagick | |
| * %s will be replaced with the source path, %d with the destination | |
| * %w and %h will be replaced with the width and height. | |
| * | |
| * **Example for GraphicMagick:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgCustomConvertCommand = "gm convert %s -resize %wx%h %d" | |
| * ``` | |
| * Leave as false to skip this. | |
| */ | |
| public const CustomConvertCommand = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * used for lossless jpeg rotation | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const JpegTran = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/jpegtran', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * At default setting of 'yuv420', JPEG thumbnails will use 4:2:0 chroma | |
| * subsampling to reduce file size, at the cost of possible color fringing | |
| * at sharp edges. | |
| * | |
| * See https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Chroma_subsampling | |
| * | |
| * Supported values: | |
| * false - use scaling system's default (same as pre-1.27 behavior) | |
| * 'yuv444' - luma and chroma at same resolution | |
| * 'yuv422' - chroma at 1/2 resolution horizontally, full vertically | |
| * 'yuv420' - chroma at 1/2 resolution in both dimensions | |
| * | |
| * This setting is currently supported only for the ImageMagick backend; | |
| * others may default to 4:2:0 or 4:4:4 or maintaining the source file's | |
| * sampling in the thumbnail. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const JpegPixelFormat = [ | |
| 'default' => 'yuv420', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When scaling a JPEG thumbnail, this is the quality we request | |
| * from the backend. It should be an integer between 1 and 100, | |
| * with 100 indicating 100% quality. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| */ | |
| public const JpegQuality = [ | |
| 'default' => 80, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Some tests and extensions use exiv2 to manipulate the Exif metadata in some | |
| * image formats. | |
| */ | |
| public const Exiv2Command = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/exiv2', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Path to exiftool binary. Used for lossless ICC profile swapping. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const Exiftool = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/exiftool', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Scalable Vector Graphics (SVG) may be uploaded as images. | |
| * | |
| * Since SVG support is not yet standard in browsers, it is | |
| * necessary to rasterize SVGs to PNG as a fallback format. | |
| * | |
| * An external program is required to perform this conversion. | |
| * If set to an array, the first item is a PHP callable and any further items | |
| * are passed as parameters after $srcPath, $dstPath, $width, $height | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGConverters = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'ImageMagick' => '$path/convert -background "#ffffff00" -thumbnail $widthx$height\\! $input PNG:$output', | |
| 'sodipodi' => '$path/sodipodi -z -w $width -f $input -e $output', | |
| 'inkscape' => '$path/inkscape -z -w $width -f $input -e $output', | |
| 'batik' => 'java -Djava.awt.headless=true -jar $path/batik-rasterizer.jar -w $width -d $output $input', | |
| 'rsvg' => '$path/rsvg-convert -w $width -h $height -o $output $input', | |
| 'imgserv' => '$path/imgserv-wrapper -i svg -o png -w$width $input $output', | |
| 'ImagickExt' => [ 'SvgHandler::rasterizeImagickExt', ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Pick a converter defined in $wgSVGConverters | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGConverter = [ | |
| 'default' => 'ImageMagick', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If not in the executable PATH, specify the SVG converter path. | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGConverterPath = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Don't scale a SVG larger than this | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGMaxSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 5120, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Don't read SVG metadata beyond this point. | |
| * | |
| * Default is 5 MiB | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGMetadataCutoff = [ | |
| 'default' => 1024 * 1024 * 5, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether native rendering by the browser agent is allowed | |
| * | |
| * Default is false. Setting it to true disables all SVG conversion. | |
| * Setting to the string 'partial' will only allow native rendering | |
| * when the filesize is below SVGNativeRenderingSizeLimit and if the | |
| * file contains at most 1 language. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGNativeRendering = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Filesize limit for allowing SVGs to render natively by the browser agent | |
| * | |
| * Default is 50kB. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const SVGNativeRenderingSizeLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 50 * 1024, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether thumbnails should be generated in target language (usually, same as | |
| * page language), if available. | |
| * | |
| * Currently, applies only to SVG images that use the systemLanguage attribute | |
| * to specify text language. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.33 | |
| */ | |
| public const MediaInTargetLanguage = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum number of pixels a source image can have if it is to be scaled | |
| * down by a scaler that requires the full source image to be decompressed | |
| * and stored in decompressed form, before the thumbnail is generated. | |
| * | |
| * This provides a limit on memory usage for the decompression side of the | |
| * image scaler. The limit is used when scaling PNGs with any of the | |
| * built-in image scalers, such as ImageMagick or GD. It is ignored for | |
| * JPEGs with ImageMagick, and when using the VipsScaler extension. | |
| * | |
| * If set to false, MediaWiki will not check the size of the image before | |
| * attempting to scale it. Extensions may still override this setting by | |
| * using the BitmapHandlerCheckImageArea hook. | |
| * | |
| * The default is 50 MB if decompressed to RGBA form, which corresponds to | |
| * 12.5 million pixels or 3500x3500. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxImageArea = [ | |
| 'default' => 12_500_000, | |
| 'type' => 'string|integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Force thumbnailing of animated GIFs above this size to a single | |
| * frame instead of an animated thumbnail. As of MW 1.17 this limit | |
| * is checked against the total size of all frames in the animation. | |
| * | |
| * | |
| * It probably makes sense to keep this equal to $wgMaxImageArea. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxAnimatedGifArea = [ | |
| 'default' => 12_500_000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Browsers don't support TIFF inline generally... | |
| * For inline display, we need to convert to PNG or JPEG. | |
| * | |
| * Note scaling should work with ImageMagick, but may not with GD scaling. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * // PNG is lossless, but inefficient for photos | |
| * $wgTiffThumbnailType = [ 'png', 'image/png' ]; | |
| * // JPEG is good for photos, but has no transparency support. Bad for diagrams. | |
| * $wgTiffThumbnailType = [ 'jpg', 'image/jpeg' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const TiffThumbnailType = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'replace', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If rendered thumbnail files are older than this timestamp, they | |
| * will be rerendered on demand as if the file didn't already exist. | |
| * | |
| * Update if there is some need to force thumbs and SVG rasterizations | |
| * to rerender, such as fixes to rendering bugs. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailEpoch = [ | |
| 'default' => '20030516000000', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Certain operations are avoided if there were too many recent failures, | |
| * for example, thumbnail generation. Bump this value to invalidate all | |
| * memory of failed operations and thus allow further attempts to resume. | |
| * | |
| * This is useful when a cause for the failures has been found and fixed. | |
| */ | |
| public const AttemptFailureEpoch = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set, inline scaled images will still produce "<img>" tags ready for | |
| * output instead of showing an error message. | |
| * | |
| * This may be useful if errors are transitory, especially if the site | |
| * is configured to automatically render thumbnails on request. | |
| * | |
| * On the other hand, it may obscure error conditions from debugging. | |
| * Enable the debug log or the 'thumbnail' log group to make sure errors | |
| * are logged to a file for review. | |
| */ | |
| public const IgnoreImageErrors = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Render thumbnails while parsing wikitext. | |
| * | |
| * If set to false, then the Parser will output valid thumbnail URLs without | |
| * generating or storing the thumbnail files. This can significantly speed up | |
| * processing on the web server. The site admin needs to configure a 404 handler | |
| * in order for the URLs in question to regenerate the thumbnails in question | |
| * on-demand. This can enable concurrency and also save computing resources | |
| * as not every resolution of every image on every page is accessed between | |
| * re-parses of the article. For example, re-parses triggered by bot edits, | |
| * or cascading updates from template edits. | |
| * | |
| * If you use $wgLocalFileRepo, then you will also need to set the following: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgLocalFileRepo['transformVia404'] = true; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.7.0 | |
| */ | |
| public const GenerateThumbnailOnParse = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show thumbnails for old images on the image description page | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowArchiveThumbnails = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set to true, images that contain certain the exif orientation tag will | |
| * be rotated accordingly. If set to null, try to auto-detect whether a scaler | |
| * is available that can rotate. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableAutoRotation = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Internal name of virus scanner. This serves as a key to the | |
| * $wgAntivirusSetup array. Set this to NULL to disable virus scanning. If not | |
| * null, every file uploaded will be scanned for viruses. | |
| */ | |
| public const Antivirus = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for different virus scanners. This an associative array of | |
| * associative arrays. It contains one setup array per known scanner type. | |
| * | |
| * The entry is selected by $wgAntivirus, i.e. | |
| * valid values for $wgAntivirus are the keys defined in this array. | |
| * | |
| * The configuration array for each scanner contains the following keys: | |
| * "command", "codemap", "messagepattern": | |
| * | |
| * "command" is the full command to call the virus scanner - %f will be | |
| * replaced with the name of the file to scan. If not present, the filename | |
| * will be appended to the command. Note that this must be overwritten if the | |
| * scanner is not in the system path; in that case, please set | |
| * $wgAntivirusSetup[$wgAntivirus]['command'] to the desired command with full | |
| * path. | |
| * | |
| * "codemap" is a mapping of exit code to return codes of the detectVirus | |
| * function in SpecialUpload. | |
| * - An exit code mapped to AV_SCAN_FAILED causes the function to consider | |
| * the scan to be failed. This will pass the file if $wgAntivirusRequired | |
| * is not set. | |
| * - An exit code mapped to AV_SCAN_ABORTED causes the function to consider | |
| * the file to have an unsupported format, which is probably immune to | |
| * viruses. This causes the file to pass. | |
| * - An exit code mapped to AV_NO_VIRUS will cause the file to pass, meaning | |
| * no virus was found. | |
| * - All other codes (like AV_VIRUS_FOUND) will cause the function to report | |
| * a virus. | |
| * - You may use "*" as a key in the array to catch all exit codes not mapped otherwise. | |
| * | |
| * "messagepattern" is a perl regular expression to extract the meaningful part of the scanners | |
| * output. The relevant part should be matched as group one (\1). | |
| * If not defined or the pattern does not match, the full message is shown to the user. | |
| */ | |
| public const AntivirusSetup = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| # setup for clamav | |
| 'clamav' => [ | |
| 'command' => 'clamscan --no-summary ', | |
| 'codemap' => [ | |
| "0" => AV_NO_VIRUS, # no virus | |
| "1" => AV_VIRUS_FOUND, # virus found | |
| "52" => AV_SCAN_ABORTED, # unsupported file format (probably immune) | |
| "*" => AV_SCAN_FAILED, # else scan failed | |
| ], | |
| 'messagepattern' => '/.*?:(.*)/sim', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Determines if a failed virus scan (AV_SCAN_FAILED) will cause the file to be rejected. | |
| */ | |
| public const AntivirusRequired = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Determines if the MIME type of uploaded files should be checked | |
| */ | |
| public const VerifyMimeType = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sets the MIME type definition file to use by includes/libs/mime/MimeAnalyzer.php. | |
| * | |
| * When this is set to the path of a mime.types file, MediaWiki will use this | |
| * file to map MIME types to file extensions and vice versa, in lieu of its | |
| * internal MIME map. Note that some MIME mappings are considered "baked in" | |
| * and cannot be overridden. See includes/libs/mime/MimeMapMinimal.php for a | |
| * full list. | |
| * example: $wgMimeTypeFile = '/etc/mime.types'; | |
| */ | |
| public const MimeTypeFile = [ | |
| 'default' => 'internal', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sets the MIME type info file to use by includes/libs/mime/MimeAnalyzer.php. | |
| * | |
| * Set to null to use the minimum set of built-in defaults only. | |
| */ | |
| public const MimeInfoFile = [ | |
| 'default' => 'internal', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sets an external MIME detector program. The command must print only | |
| * the MIME type to standard output. | |
| * | |
| * The name of the file to process will be appended to the command given here. | |
| * If not set or NULL, PHP's mime_content_type function will be used. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * #$wgMimeDetectorCommand = "file -bi"; // use external MIME detector (Linux) | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const MimeDetectorCommand = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Switch for trivial MIME detection. Used by thumb.php to disable all fancy | |
| * things, because only a few types of images are needed and file extensions | |
| * can be trusted. | |
| */ | |
| public const TrivialMimeDetection = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional XML types we can allow via MIME-detection. | |
| * | |
| * array = [ 'rootElement' => 'associatedMimeType' ] | |
| */ | |
| public const XMLMimeTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'http://www.w3.org/2000/svg:svg' => 'image/svg+xml', | |
| 'svg' => 'image/svg+xml', | |
| 'http://www.lysator.liu.se/~alla/dia/:diagram' => 'application/x-dia-diagram', | |
| 'http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml:html' => 'text/html', | |
| 'html' => 'text/html', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Limit images on image description pages to a user-selectable limit. | |
| * | |
| * In order to reduce disk usage, limits can only be selected from this list. | |
| * The user preference is saved as an array offset in the database, by default | |
| * the offset is set with $wgDefaultUserOptions['imagesize']. Make sure you | |
| * change it if you alter the array (see T10858). | |
| * | |
| * This list is also used by ImagePage for alternate size links. | |
| */ | |
| public const ImageLimits = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| [ 320, 240 ], | |
| [ 640, 480 ], | |
| [ 800, 600 ], | |
| [ 1024, 768 ], | |
| [ 1280, 1024 ], | |
| [ 2560, 2048 ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Adjust thumbnails on image pages according to a user setting. In order to | |
| * reduce disk usage, the values can only be selected from a list. This is the | |
| * list of settings the user can choose from: | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbLimits = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 120, | |
| 150, | |
| 180, | |
| 200, | |
| 250, | |
| 300 | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Defines what namespaces thumbnails will be displayed for in Special:Search. | |
| * This is the list of namespaces for which thumbnails (or a placeholder in | |
| * the absence of a thumbnail) will be shown: | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [ NS_FILE ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'integer', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When defined, is an array of image widths used as steps for thumbnail sizes. | |
| * | |
| * The thumbnail with smallest step that has larger value than requested will be shown | |
| * but it will be downsized via HTML values. | |
| * | |
| * It increases the bandwidth to the users by serving slightly large thumbnail sizes they | |
| * have requested but it will save resources by de-duplicating thumbnail generation and storage. | |
| * | |
| * Note that these steps are "best effort" and MediaWiki might decide to use the requested size | |
| * for any reason. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailSteps = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Ratio of images that will use the thumbnail steps | |
| * | |
| * This is to allow for gradual roll out of thumbnail steps. It should be a number between 0 and 1. | |
| * | |
| * The precision of this value is up to 0.001, anything below that will be ignored. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailStepsRatio = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When defined, is an array of image widths used as buckets for thumbnail generation. | |
| * | |
| * The goal is to save resources by generating thumbnails based on reference buckets instead of | |
| * always using the original. This will incur a speed gain but cause a quality loss. | |
| * | |
| * The buckets generation is chained, with each bucket generated based on the above bucket | |
| * when possible. File handlers have to opt into using that feature. For now only BitmapHandler | |
| * supports it. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailBuckets = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When using thumbnail buckets as defined above, this sets the minimum distance to the bucket | |
| * above the requested size. The distance represents how many extra pixels of width the bucket | |
| * needs in order to be used as the reference for a given thumbnail. For example, with the | |
| * following buckets: | |
| * | |
| * $wgThumbnailBuckets = [ 128, 256, 512 ]; | |
| * | |
| * and a distance of 50: | |
| * | |
| * $wgThumbnailMinimumBucketDistance = 50; | |
| * | |
| * If we want to render a thumbnail of width 220px, the 512px bucket will be used, | |
| * because 220 + 50 = 270 and the closest bucket bigger than 270px is 512. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbnailMinimumBucketDistance = [ | |
| 'default' => 50, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When defined, is an array of thumbnail widths to be rendered at upload time. The idea is to | |
| * prerender common thumbnail sizes, in order to avoid the necessity to render them on demand, | |
| * which has a performance impact for the first client to view a certain size. | |
| * | |
| * This obviously means that more disk space is needed per upload upfront. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadThumbnailRenderMap = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The method through which the thumbnails will be prerendered for the entries in | |
| * $wgUploadThumbnailRenderMap | |
| * | |
| * The method can be either "http" or "jobqueue". The former uses an http request to hit the | |
| * thumbnail's URL. | |
| * This method only works if thumbnails are configured to be rendered by a 404 handler. The | |
| * latter option uses the job queue to render the thumbnail. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadThumbnailRenderMethod = [ | |
| 'default' => 'jobqueue', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When using the "http" $wgUploadThumbnailRenderMethod, lets one specify a custom Host HTTP | |
| * header. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadThumbnailRenderHttpCustomHost = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When using the "http" $wgUploadThumbnailRenderMethod, lets one specify a custom domain to | |
| * send the HTTP request to. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const UploadThumbnailRenderHttpCustomDomain = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When this variable is true and JPGs use the sRGB ICC profile, swaps it for the more | |
| * lightweight | |
| * (and free) TinyRGB profile when generating thumbnails. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseTinyRGBForJPGThumbnails = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Parameters for the "<gallery>" tag. | |
| * | |
| * Fields are: | |
| * - imagesPerRow: Default number of images per-row in the gallery. 0 -> Adapt to screensize | |
| * - imageWidth: Width of the cells containing images in galleries (in "px") | |
| * - imageHeight: Height of the cells containing images in galleries (in "px") | |
| * - captionLength: Length to truncate filename to in caption when using "showfilename". | |
| * A value of 'true' will truncate the filename to one line using CSS | |
| * and will be the behaviour after deprecation. | |
| * @deprecated since 1.28 | |
| * - showBytes: Show the filesize in bytes in categories | |
| * - showDimensions: Show the dimensions (width x height) in categories | |
| * - mode: Gallery mode | |
| */ | |
| public const GalleryOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Adjust width of upright images when parameter 'upright' is used | |
| * This allows a nicer look for upright images without the need to fix the width | |
| * by hardcoded px in wiki sourcecode. | |
| */ | |
| public const ThumbUpright = [ | |
| 'default' => 0.75, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default value for chmod-ing of new directories. | |
| */ | |
| public const DirectoryMode = [ | |
| 'default' => 0o777, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Generate and use thumbnails suitable for screens with 1.5 and 2.0 pixel densities. | |
| * | |
| * This means a 320x240 use of an image on the wiki will also generate 480x360 and 640x480 | |
| * thumbnails, output via the srcset attribute. | |
| */ | |
| public const ResponsiveImages = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Add a preconnect link for browsers to a remote FileRepo host. | |
| * | |
| * This is an optional performance enhancement designed for wiki farm where | |
| * $wgForeignFileRepos or $wgLocalFileRepo is set to serve thumbnails from a | |
| * separate hostname (e.g. not local `/w/images`). The feature expects at most | |
| * a single remote hostname to be used. | |
| * | |
| * If multiple foreign repos are registered that serve images from different hostnames, | |
| * only the first will be preconnected. | |
| * | |
| * This may cause unneeded HTTP connections in browsers on wikis where a foreign repo is | |
| * enabled but where a local repo is more commonly used. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const ImagePreconnect = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region DJVU settings | |
| /** @name DJVU settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use BoxedCommand or not. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable Temporary feature flag for T352515 | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuUseBoxedCommand = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Path of the djvudump executable | |
| * Enable this and $wgDjvuRenderer to enable djvu rendering | |
| * example: $wgDjvuDump = 'djvudump'; | |
| * | |
| * If this is set, {@link self::ShellboxShell} must be set to the correct | |
| * shell path. | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuDump = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Path of the ddjvu DJVU renderer | |
| * Enable this and $wgDjvuDump to enable djvu rendering | |
| * example: $wgDjvuRenderer = 'ddjvu'; | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuRenderer = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Path of the djvutxt DJVU text extraction utility | |
| * Enable this and $wgDjvuDump to enable text layer extraction from djvu files | |
| * example: $wgDjvuTxt = 'djvutxt'; | |
| * | |
| * If this is set, {@link self::ShellboxShell} must be set to the correct | |
| * shell path. | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuTxt = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shell command for the DJVU post processor | |
| * Default: pnmtojpeg, since ddjvu generates ppm output | |
| * Set this to false to output the ppm file directly. | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuPostProcessor = [ | |
| 'default' => 'pnmtojpeg', | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * File extension for the DJVU post processor output | |
| */ | |
| public const DjvuOutputExtension = [ | |
| 'default' => 'jpg', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of DJvu | |
| // endregion -- end of file uploads | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Email settings | |
| /** @name Email settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Site admin email address. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "wikiadmin@$wgServerName" (in Setup.php). | |
| */ | |
| public const EmergencyContact = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sender email address for e-mail notifications. | |
| * | |
| * The address we use as sender when a user requests a password reminder, | |
| * as well as other e-mail notifications. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to "apache@$wgServerName" (in Setup.php). | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordSender = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Reply-To address for e-mail notifications. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to $wgPasswordSender (in Setup.php). | |
| */ | |
| public const NoReplyAddress = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to true to enable the e-mail basic features: | |
| * Password reminders, etc. If sending e-mail on your | |
| * server doesn't work, you might want to disable this. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableEmail = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to true to enable user-to-user e-mail. | |
| * | |
| * This can potentially be abused, as it's hard to track. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableUserEmail = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to true to enable the Special Mute page. This allows users | |
| * to mute unwanted communications from other users, and is linked | |
| * to from emails originating from Special:Email. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableSpecialMute = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to true to enable user-to-user e-mail mutelist. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37; previously $wgEnableUserEmailBlacklist | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableUserEmailMuteList = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true put the sending user's email in a Reply-To header | |
| * instead of From (false). ($wgPasswordSender will be used as From.) | |
| * | |
| * Some mailers (eg SMTP) set the SMTP envelope sender to the From value, | |
| * which can cause problems with SPF validation and leak recipient addresses | |
| * when bounces are sent to the sender. In addition, DMARC restrictions | |
| * can cause emails to fail to be received when false. | |
| */ | |
| public const UserEmailUseReplyTo = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Minimum time, in hours, which must elapse between password reminder | |
| * emails for a given account. This is to prevent abuse by mail flooding. | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordReminderResendTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 24, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The time, in seconds, when an emailed temporary password expires. | |
| */ | |
| public const NewPasswordExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 3600 * 24 * 7, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The time, in seconds, when an email confirmation email expires | |
| */ | |
| public const UserEmailConfirmationTokenExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 7 * 24 * 60 * 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The number of days that a user's password is good for. After this number of days, the | |
| * user will be asked to reset their password. Set to false to disable password expiration. | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordExpirationDays = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If a user's password is expired, the number of seconds when they can still login, | |
| * and cancel their password change, but are sent to the password change form on each login. | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordExpireGrace = [ | |
| 'default' => 3600 * 24 * 7, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * SMTP Mode. | |
| * | |
| * For using a direct (authenticated) SMTP server connection. | |
| * Default to false or fill an array : | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgSMTP = [ | |
| * 'host' => 'SMTP domain', | |
| * 'IDHost' => 'domain for MessageID', | |
| * 'port' => '25', | |
| * 'auth' => [true|false], | |
| * 'username' => [SMTP username], | |
| * 'password' => [SMTP password], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const SMTP = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional email parameters, will be passed as the last argument to mail() call. | |
| */ | |
| public const AdditionalMailParams = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * For parts of the system that have been updated to provide HTML email content, send | |
| * both text and HTML parts as the body of the email | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowHTMLEmail = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow sending of e-mail notifications with the editor's address as sender. | |
| * | |
| * This setting depends on $wgEnotifRevealEditorAddress also being enabled. | |
| * If both are enabled, notifications for actions from users that have opted-in, | |
| * will be sent to other users with their address as "From" instead of "Reply-To". | |
| * | |
| * If disabled, or not opted-in, notifications come from $wgPasswordSender. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifFromEditor = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Require email authentication before sending mail to an email address. | |
| * | |
| * This is highly recommended. It prevents MediaWiki from being used as an open | |
| * spam relay. | |
| */ | |
| public const EmailAuthentication = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow users to enable email notification ("enotif") on watchlist changes. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifWatchlist = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow users to enable email notification ("enotif") when someone edits their | |
| * user talk page. | |
| * | |
| * The owner of the user talk page must also have the 'enotifusertalkpages' user | |
| * preference set to true. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifUserTalk = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow sending of e-mail notifications with the editor's address in "Reply-To". | |
| * | |
| * Note, enabling this only actually uses it in notification e-mails if the user | |
| * opted-in to this feature. This feature flag also controls visibility of the | |
| * 'enotifrevealaddr' preference, which, if users opt into, will make e-mail | |
| * notifications about their actions use their address as "Reply-To". | |
| * | |
| * To set the address as "From" instead of "Reply-To", also enable $wgEnotifFromEditor. | |
| * | |
| * If disabled, or not opted-in, notifications come from $wgPasswordSender. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifRevealEditorAddress = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Potentially send notification mails on minor edits to pages. This is enabled | |
| * by default. If this is false, users will never be notified on minor edits. | |
| * | |
| * If it is true, editors with the 'nominornewtalk' right (typically bots) will still not | |
| * trigger notifications for minor edits they make (to any page, not just user talk). | |
| * | |
| * Finally, if the watcher/recipient has the 'enotifminoredits' user preference set to | |
| * false, they will not receive notifications for minor edits. | |
| * | |
| * User talk notifications are also affected by $wgEnotifMinorEdits, the above settings, | |
| * $wgEnotifUserTalk, and the preference described there. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifMinorEdits = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use real name instead of username in e-mail "from" field. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnotifUseRealName = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of usernames who will be sent a notification email for every change | |
| * which occurs on a wiki. Users will not be notified of their own changes. | |
| */ | |
| public const UsersNotifiedOnAllChanges = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of email settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Database settings | |
| /** @name Database settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Current wiki database name | |
| * | |
| * This should only contain alphanumeric and underscore characters ([A-Za-z0-9_]+). | |
| * Spaces, quotes, backticks, dots, and hyphens are likely to be problematic. | |
| * | |
| * This is used to determine the current/local wiki ID (WikiMap::getCurrentWikiDbDomain). | |
| * | |
| * This should still be set even if $wgLBFactoryConf is configured. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBname = [ | |
| 'default' => 'my_wiki', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Current wiki database schema name | |
| * | |
| * This should only contain alphanumeric and underscore characters ([A-Za-z0-9_]+). | |
| * Spaces, quotes, backticks, dots, and hyphens are likely to be problematic. | |
| * | |
| * This is used to determine the current/local wiki ID (WikiMap::getCurrentWikiDbDomain). | |
| * | |
| * This should still be set even if $wgLBFactoryConf is configured. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBmwschema = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Current wiki database table name prefix | |
| * | |
| * This should only contain alphanumeric and underscore characters ([A-Za-z0-9_]+). | |
| * If it's a non-empty string, then it preferably should end with an underscore. | |
| * Spaces, quotes, backticks, dots, and hyphens are especially likely to be problematic. | |
| * | |
| * This is used to determine the current/local wiki ID (WikiMap::getCurrentWikiDbDomain). | |
| * | |
| * This should still be set even if $wgLBFactoryConf is configured. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBprefix = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database host name or IP address | |
| */ | |
| public const DBserver = [ | |
| 'default' => 'localhost', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database port number | |
| */ | |
| public const DBport = [ | |
| 'default' => 5432, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database username | |
| */ | |
| public const DBuser = [ | |
| 'default' => 'wikiuser', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database user's password | |
| */ | |
| public const DBpassword = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database type | |
| */ | |
| public const DBtype = [ | |
| 'default' => 'mysql', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use SSL in DB connection. | |
| * | |
| * This setting is only used if $wgLBFactoryConf['class'] is set to | |
| * '\Wikimedia\Rdbms\LBFactorySimple' and $wgDBservers is an empty array; otherwise | |
| * the 'ssl' parameter of the server array must be set to achieve the same functionality. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBssl = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use compression in DB connection. | |
| * | |
| * This setting is only used $wgLBFactoryConf['class'] is set to | |
| * '\Wikimedia\Rdbms\LBFactorySimple' and $wgDBservers is an empty array; otherwise | |
| * the DBO_COMPRESS flag must be set in the 'flags' option of the database | |
| * connection to achieve the same functionality. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBcompress = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Check for warnings after DB queries and throw an exception if an | |
| * unacceptable warning is detected. | |
| * | |
| * This setting is only used if $wgLBFactoryConf['class'] is set to | |
| * '\Wikimedia\Rdbms\LBFactorySimple' and $wgDBservers is an empty array. | |
| * Otherwise, the 'strictWarnings' parameter of the server array must be set | |
| * to achieve the same functionality. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const DBStrictWarnings = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Separate username for maintenance tasks. Leave as null to use the default. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBadminuser = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Separate password for maintenance tasks. Leave as null to use the default. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBadminpassword = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Search type. | |
| * | |
| * Leave as null to select the default search engine for the | |
| * selected database type (eg SearchMySQL), or set to a class | |
| * name to override to a custom search engine. | |
| * | |
| * If the canonical name for the search engine doesn't match the class name | |
| * (because it's namespaced for example), you can add a mapping for this in | |
| * SearchMappings in extension.json. | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchType = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Alternative search types | |
| * | |
| * Sometimes you want to support multiple search engines for testing. This | |
| * allows users to select their search engine of choice via url parameters | |
| * to Special:Search and the action=search API. If using this, there's no | |
| * need to add $wgSearchType to it, that is handled automatically. | |
| * | |
| * If the canonical name for the search engine doesn't match the class name | |
| * (because it's namespaced for example), you can add a mapping for this in | |
| * SearchMappings in extension.json. | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchTypeAlternatives = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * MySQL table options to use during installation or update | |
| */ | |
| public const DBTableOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => 'ENGINE=InnoDB, DEFAULT CHARSET=binary', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * SQL Mode - default is turning off all modes, including strict, if set. | |
| * | |
| * null can be used to skip the setting for performance reasons and assume | |
| * the DBA has done their best job. | |
| * String override can be used for some additional fun :-) | |
| */ | |
| public const SQLMode = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * To override default SQLite data directory ($docroot/../data) | |
| */ | |
| public const SQLiteDataDir = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shared database for multiple wikis. Commonly used for storing a user table | |
| * for single sign-on. The server for this database must be the same as for the | |
| * main database. | |
| * | |
| * For backwards compatibility the shared prefix is set to the same as the local | |
| * prefix, and the user table is listed in the default list of shared tables. | |
| * The user_properties table is also added so that users will continue to have their | |
| * preferences shared (preferences were stored in the user table prior to 1.16) | |
| * | |
| * $wgSharedTables may be customized with a list of tables to share in the shared | |
| * database. However it is advised to limit what tables you do share as many of | |
| * MediaWiki's tables may have side effects if you try to share them. | |
| * | |
| * $wgSharedPrefix is the table prefix for the shared database. It defaults to | |
| * $wgDBprefix. | |
| * | |
| * $wgSharedSchema is the table schema for the shared database. It defaults to | |
| * $wgDBmwschema. | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedDB = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::SharedDB | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedPrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'DBprefix' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $dbPrefix Value of DBprefix | |
| * @return mixed | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultSharedPrefix( $dbPrefix ) { | |
| return $dbPrefix; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::SharedDB | |
| * The installer will add 'actor' to this list for all new wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedTables = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'user', | |
| 'user_properties', | |
| 'user_autocreate_serial', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::SharedDB | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const SharedSchema = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'DBmwschema' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $dbMwschema Value of DBmwschema | |
| * @return mixed | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultSharedSchema( $dbMwschema ) { | |
| return $dbMwschema; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Database load balancer | |
| * This is a two-dimensional array, a list of server info structures | |
| * Fields are: | |
| * - host: Host name | |
| * - dbname: Default database name | |
| * - user: DB user | |
| * - password: DB password | |
| * - type: DB type | |
| * - driver: DB driver (when there are multiple drivers) | |
| * | |
| * - load: Ratio of DB_REPLICA load, must be >=0, the sum of all loads must be >0. | |
| * If this is zero for any given server, no normal query traffic will be | |
| * sent to it. It will be excluded from lag checks in maintenance scripts. | |
| * The only way it can receive traffic is if groupLoads is used. | |
| * | |
| * - groupLoads: (optional) Array of load ratios, the key is the query group name. A query | |
| * may belong to several groups, the most specific group defined here is used. | |
| * | |
| * - flags: (optional) Bit field of properties: | |
| * - DBO_DEFAULT: Transactional-ize web requests and use autocommit otherwise | |
| * - DBO_DEBUG: Equivalent of $wgDebugDumpSql | |
| * - DBO_SSL: Use TLS connection encryption if available (deprecated) | |
| * - DBO_COMPRESS: Use protocol compression with database connections | |
| * - DBO_PERSISTENT: Enables persistent database connections | |
| * | |
| * - ssl: (optional) Boolean, whether to use TLS encryption. Overrides DBO_SSL. | |
| * - max lag: (optional) Maximum replication lag before a replica DB goes out of rotation | |
| * - is static: (optional) Set to true if the dataset is static and no replication is used. | |
| * - cliMode: (optional) Connection handles will not assume that requests are short-lived | |
| * nor that INSERT..SELECT can be rewritten into a buffered SELECT and INSERT. | |
| * This is what DBO_DEFAULT uses to determine when a web request is present. | |
| * [Default: true if MW_ENTRY_POINT is 'cli', otherwise false] | |
| * | |
| * These and any other user-defined properties will be assigned to the mLBInfo member | |
| * variable of the Database object. | |
| * | |
| * Leave at false to use the single-server variables above. If you set this | |
| * variable, the single-server variables will generally be ignored (except | |
| * perhaps in some command-line scripts). | |
| * | |
| * The first server listed in this array (with key 0) will be the primary. The | |
| * rest of the servers will be replica DBs. To prevent writes to your replica DBs due to | |
| * accidental misconfiguration or MediaWiki bugs, set read_only=1 on all your | |
| * replica DBs in my.cnf. You can set read_only mode at runtime using: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * SET @@read_only=1; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Since the effect of writing to a replica DB is so damaging and difficult to clean | |
| * up, we at Wikimedia set read_only=1 in my.cnf on all our DB servers, even | |
| * our primaries, and then set read_only=0 on primaries at runtime. | |
| */ | |
| public const DBservers = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for the ILBFactory service | |
| * | |
| * The "class" setting must point to a LBFactory subclass, which is also responsible | |
| * for reading $wgDBservers, $wgDBserver, etc. | |
| * | |
| * To set up a wiki farm with multiple database clusters, set the "class" to | |
| * LBFactoryMulti. See {@link Wikimedia::Rdbms::LBFactoryMulti LBFactoryMulti} docs for | |
| * information on how to configure the rest of the $wgLBFactoryConf array. | |
| */ | |
| public const LBFactoryConf = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'class' => 'Wikimedia\\Rdbms\\LBFactorySimple', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'replace', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * After a state-changing request is done by a client, this determines | |
| * how many seconds that client should keep using the primary datacenter. | |
| * | |
| * This avoids unexpected stale or 404 responses due to replication lag. | |
| * | |
| * This must be greater than or equal to | |
| * Wikimedia\Rdbms\ChronologyProtector::POSITION_COOKIE_TTL. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const DataCenterUpdateStickTTL = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * File to log database errors to | |
| */ | |
| public const DBerrorLog = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Timezone to use in the error log. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to the wiki timezone ($wgLocaltimezone). | |
| * | |
| * A list of usable timezones can found at: | |
| * https://www.php.net/manual/en/timezones.php | |
| * | |
| * **Examples:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDBerrorLogTZ = 'UTC'; | |
| * $wgDBerrorLogTZ = 'GMT'; | |
| * $wgDBerrorLogTZ = 'PST8PDT'; | |
| * $wgDBerrorLogTZ = 'Europe/Sweden'; | |
| * $wgDBerrorLogTZ = 'CET'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const DBerrorLogTZ = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'Localtimezone' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultDBerrorLogTZ( ?string $localtimezone ): string { | |
| // NOTE: Extra fallback, in case $localtimezone is ''. | |
| // Many extsing LocalSettings files have $wgLocaltimezone = '' | |
| // in them, erroneously generated by the installer. | |
| return $localtimezone ?: self::getDefaultLocaltimezone(); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * List of all wiki IDs that reside on the current wiki farm. | |
| * | |
| * The wikis listed here must meet the following requirements in order to | |
| * be be considered part of the same wiki farm: | |
| * | |
| * - reachable for cross-wiki database queries, via \Wikimedia\Rdbms\IConnectionProvider, | |
| * as configured by $wgLBFactoryConf | |
| * - share the same $wgMainCacheType backend (e.g. the same Memcached cluster), | |
| * so that cache updates and purges via BagOStuff::makeGlobalKey and | |
| * WANObjectCache work correctly. | |
| * | |
| * Examples of cross-wiki features enabled through this setting: | |
| * | |
| * - SpecialUserRights, to assign a local user group from a central wiki. | |
| * - JobQueueGroup::push, to queue a job for another wiki | |
| * (e.g. GlobalUsage, MassMessage, and Wikibase extensions). | |
| * - RenameUser (when using $wgSharedDB), to globally apply the rename to revisions | |
| * logging tables on all wikis. | |
| * | |
| * Each wiki ID must consist of 1-3 hyphen-delimited alphanumeric components (each with no | |
| * hyphens nor spaces) of any of the forms: | |
| * | |
| * - "<DB NAME>" | |
| * - "<DB NAME>-<TABLE PREFIX>" | |
| * - "<DB NAME>-<DB SCHEMA>-<TABLE PREFIX>" | |
| * | |
| * If hyphens appear in any of the components, then the domain ID parsing may not work | |
| * and site functionality might be affected. If the schema ($wgDBmwschema) is set to the | |
| * default of "mediawiki" on all wikis, then the schema should be omitted from wiki IDs. | |
| * | |
| * @see WikiMap::getWikiIdFromDbDomain | |
| * @see SiteConfiguration::getLocalDatabases | |
| * @see self::LocalVirtualHosts | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalDatabases = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If lag is higher than $wgDatabaseReplicaLagWarning, show a warning in some special | |
| * pages (like watchlist). If the lag is higher than $wgDatabaseReplicaLagCritical, | |
| * show a more obvious warning. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const DatabaseReplicaLagWarning = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::DatabaseReplicaLagWarning | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const DatabaseReplicaLagCritical = [ | |
| 'default' => 30, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Max execution time for queries of several expensive special pages such as RecentChanges | |
| * in milliseconds. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxExecutionTimeForExpensiveQueries = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Mapping of virtual domain to external cluster db. | |
| * | |
| * If no entry is set, the code assumes local database. | |
| * For example, for routing queries of virtual domain 'vdomain' | |
| * to 'wikishared' database in 'extension1' cluster. The config should be like this: | |
| * [ 'vdomain' => [ 'cluster' => 'extension1', 'db' => 'wikishared' ] ] | |
| * | |
| * If the database needs to be the local domain, just set the 'db' to false. | |
| * | |
| * If you want to get another db in the main cluster, just omit 'cluster'. For example: | |
| * [ 'centralauth' => [ 'db' => 'centralauth' ] ] | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const VirtualDomainsMapping = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Migration stage for file tables | |
| * | |
| * Use the SCHEMA_COMPAT_XXX flags. Supported values: | |
| * | |
| * - SCHEMA_COMPAT_WRITE_OLD | SCHEMA_COMPAT_READ_OLD (SCHEMA_COMPAT_OLD) | |
| * - SCHEMA_COMPAT_WRITE_BOTH | SCHEMA_COMPAT_READ_OLD | |
| * | |
| * History: | |
| * - 1.44: Added | |
| */ | |
| public const FileSchemaMigrationStage = [ | |
| 'default' => SCHEMA_COMPAT_OLD, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Gaps in the externallinks table for certain domains. | |
| * | |
| * If you have identified certain domains for which externallinks searches are slow, | |
| * you can use this setting to make MediaWiki skip large el_id ranges, | |
| * rather than having the database scan through them fruitlessly. | |
| * | |
| * Each key in the array is a domain name in el_to_domain_index form, | |
| * e.g. 'https://com.example.'. | |
| * The value is an array with integer keys and values, | |
| * where each entry is a range (from => to, both inclusive) | |
| * of el_id values where this domain is known to have no entries. | |
| * (Subdomains are included, i.e., configuring an entry here guarantees to MediaWiki | |
| * that there are no rows where the el_to_domain_index starts with this value.) | |
| * | |
| * History: | |
| * - 1.41: Added | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalLinksDomainGaps = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of DB settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Content handlers and storage | |
| /** @name Content handlers and storage */ | |
| /** | |
| * Plugins for page content model handling. | |
| * | |
| * Each entry in the array maps a model id to an ObjectFactory specification | |
| * that creates an instance of the appropriate ContentHandler subclass. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const ContentHandlers = [ | |
| 'default' => | |
| [ | |
| // the usual case | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_WIKITEXT => [ | |
| 'class' => WikitextContentHandler::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleFactory', | |
| 'ParserFactory', | |
| 'GlobalIdGenerator', | |
| 'LanguageNameUtils', | |
| 'LinkRenderer', | |
| 'MagicWordFactory', | |
| 'ParsoidParserFactory', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| // dumb version, no syntax highlighting | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_JAVASCRIPT => [ | |
| 'class' => JavaScriptContentHandler::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'ParserFactory', | |
| 'UserOptionsLookup', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| // simple implementation, for use by extensions, etc. | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_JSON => [ | |
| 'class' => JsonContentHandler::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'ParsoidParserFactory', | |
| 'TitleFactory', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| // dumb version, no syntax highlighting | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_CSS => [ | |
| 'class' => CssContentHandler::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'ParserFactory', | |
| 'UserOptionsLookup', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_VUE => [ | |
| 'class' => VueContentHandler::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'ParserFactory', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| // plain text, for use by extensions, etc. | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_TEXT => TextContentHandler::class, | |
| // fallback for unknown models, from imports or extensions that were removed | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_UNKNOWN => FallbackContentHandler::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Associative array mapping namespace IDs to the name of the content model pages in that | |
| * namespace should have by default (use the CONTENT_MODEL_XXX constants). If no special | |
| * content type is defined for a given namespace, pages in that namespace will use the | |
| * CONTENT_MODEL_WIKITEXT | |
| * (except for the special case of JS and CS pages). | |
| * | |
| * @note To determine the default model for a new page's main slot, or any slot in general, | |
| * use SlotRoleHandler::getDefaultModel() together with SlotRoleRegistry::getRoleHandler(). | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespaceContentModels = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Determines which types of text are parsed as wikitext. This does not imply that these kinds | |
| * of texts are also rendered as wikitext, it only means that links, magic words, etc will have | |
| * the effect on the database they would have on a wikitext page. | |
| * | |
| * Note that table of contents information will be *suppressed* for all | |
| * text models in this list other than wikitext. | |
| * | |
| * @todo Make the ToC suppression configurable by the content model | |
| * (T313455), not a side effect of inclusion here. | |
| * | |
| * @todo On the long run, it would be nice to put categories etc into a separate structure, | |
| * or at least parse only the contents of comments in the scripts. | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const TextModelsToParse = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_WIKITEXT, // Just for completeness, wikitext will always be parsed. | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_JAVASCRIPT, // Make categories etc work, people put them into comments. | |
| CONTENT_MODEL_CSS, // Make categories etc work, people put them into comments. | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * We can also compress text stored in the 'text' table. If this is set on, new | |
| * revisions will be compressed on page save if zlib support is available. Any | |
| * compressed revisions will be decompressed on load regardless of this setting, | |
| * but will not be readable at all if zlib support is not available. | |
| */ | |
| public const CompressRevisions = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of enabled ExternalStore protocols. | |
| * | |
| * @see \ExternalStoreAccess | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExternalStores = [ "DB" ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalStores = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortcut for setting `$wgLBFactoryConf["externalClusters"]`. | |
| * | |
| * This is only applicable when using the default LBFactory | |
| * of {@link Wikimedia::Rdbms::LBFactorySimple LBFactorySimple}. | |
| * It is ignored if a different LBFactory is set, or if `externalClusters` | |
| * is already set explicitly. | |
| * | |
| * @see \ExternalStoreAccess | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Create a cluster named 'blobs_cluster1': | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExternalServers = [ | |
| * 'blobs_cluster1' => <array in the same format as $wgDBservers> | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalServers = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The place to put new text blobs or false to put them in the text table | |
| * of the local wiki database. | |
| * | |
| * @see \ExternalStoreAccess | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDefaultExternalStore = [ 'DB://cluster1', 'DB://cluster2' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const DefaultExternalStore = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'list|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Revision text may be cached in the main WAN cache to reduce load on external | |
| * storage servers and object extraction overhead for frequently-loaded revisions. | |
| * | |
| * Set to 0 to disable, or number of seconds before cache expiry. | |
| */ | |
| public const RevisionCacheExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => SqlBlobStore::DEFAULT_TTL, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable page language feature | |
| * Allows setting page language in database | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const PageLanguageUseDB = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Specify the difference engine to use. | |
| * | |
| * Supported values: | |
| * - 'external': Use an external diff engine, which must be specified via $wgExternalDiffEngine | |
| * - 'wikidiff2': Use the wikidiff2 PHP extension | |
| * - 'php': PHP implementations included in MediaWiki | |
| * | |
| * The default (null) is to use the first engine that's available. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const DiffEngine = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Name of the external diff engine to use. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalDiffEngine = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Options for wikidiff2: | |
| * - useMultiFormat: (bool) Whether to use wikidiff2_multi_format_diff() | |
| * if it is available. This temporarily defaults to false, during | |
| * migration to the new code. It is available in wikidiff2 1.14.0+. | |
| * | |
| * The following options are only effective if wikidiff2_multi_format_diff() | |
| * is enabled. See README.md in wikidiff2 for details: | |
| * | |
| * - numContextLines | |
| * - changeThreshold | |
| * - movedLineThreshold | |
| * - maxMovedLines | |
| * - maxWordLevelDiffComplexity | |
| * - maxSplitSize | |
| * - initialSplitThreshold | |
| * - finalSplitThreshold | |
| * | |
| * Also: | |
| * - formatOptions: An array of format-specific overrides. The key may | |
| * be "inline" or "table" and the value is an array with keys | |
| * numContextLines, changeThreshold, etc. | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const Wikidiff2Options = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map' | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of Content handlers and storage | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Performance hacks and limits | |
| /** @name Performance hacks and limits */ | |
| /** | |
| * Set a limit on server request wall clock time. | |
| * | |
| * If the Excimer extension is enabled, setting this will cause an exception | |
| * to be thrown after the specified number of seconds. If the extension is | |
| * not available, set_time_limit() will be called instead. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const RequestTimeLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The request time limit for "slow" write requests that should not be | |
| * interrupted due to the risk of data corruption. | |
| * | |
| * The limit will only be raised. If the pre-existing time limit is larger, | |
| * then this will have no effect. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const TransactionalTimeLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 120, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum time critical sections are allowed to stay open. Critical | |
| * sections are used to defer Excimer request timeouts. If Excimer is available | |
| * and this time limit is exceeded, an exception will be thrown at the next | |
| * opportunity, typically after a long-running function like a DB query returns. | |
| * | |
| * Critical sections may wrap long-running queries, and it's generally better | |
| * for the timeout to be handled a few milliseconds later when the critical | |
| * section exits, so this should be a large number. | |
| * | |
| * This limit is ignored in command-line mode. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const CriticalSectionTimeLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 180.0, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable database-intensive features | |
| */ | |
| public const MiserMode = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable all query pages if miser mode is on, not just some | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableQueryPages = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of rows to cache in 'querycache' table when miser mode is on | |
| */ | |
| public const QueryCacheLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 1000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of links to a page required before it is deemed "wanted" | |
| */ | |
| public const WantedPagesThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable slow parser functions | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowSlowParserFunctions = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow schema updates | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowSchemaUpdates = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum article size in kibibytes | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxArticleSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 2048, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The minimum amount of memory that MediaWiki "needs"; MediaWiki will try to | |
| * raise PHP's memory limit if it's below this amount. | |
| */ | |
| public const MemoryLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => '50M', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for processing pool control, for use in high-traffic wikis. | |
| * | |
| * An implementation is provided in the PoolCounter extension. | |
| * | |
| * This configuration array maps pool types to an associative array. The only | |
| * defined key in the associative array is "class", which gives the class name. | |
| * The remaining elements are passed through to the class as constructor | |
| * parameters. | |
| * | |
| * **Processing pools used in MediaWiki core:** | |
| * - ArticleView: parsing caused by users viewing a wiki page (per page and revision) | |
| * - HtmlRestApi: parsing caused by requests to the REST API (per page and revision) | |
| * - ApiParser: parsing caused by action=parse (per requesting user) | |
| * - FileRender: thumbnail generation (per file name) | |
| * - FileRenderExpensive: expensive thumbnail generation (per file name) | |
| * - GetLocalFileCopy: expensive thumbnail generation (per file name) | |
| * - diff: revision diff (per content hash) | |
| * - SpecialContributions: list user contributions (per requesting user) | |
| * | |
| * **Example using local redis instance:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgPoolCounterConf = [ 'ArticleView' => [ | |
| * 'class' => PoolCounterRedis::class, | |
| * 'timeout' => 15, // wait timeout in seconds | |
| * 'workers' => 1, // maximum number of active threads in each pool | |
| * 'maxqueue' => 5, // maximum number of total threads in each pool | |
| * 'servers' => [ '127.0.0.1' ], | |
| * 'redisConfig' => [] | |
| * ] ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example using C daemon from <https://gerrit.wikimedia.org/g/mediawiki/services/poolcounter>** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgPoolCountClientConf = [ | |
| * 'servers' => [ '127.0.0.1' ], | |
| * 'timeout' => 0.5, | |
| * 'connect_timeout' => 0.01, | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * $wgPoolCounterConf = [ 'ArticleView' => [ | |
| * 'class' => 'PoolCounter_Client', | |
| * 'timeout' => 15, // wait timeout in seconds | |
| * 'workers' => 5, // maximum number of active threads in each pool | |
| * 'maxqueue' => 50, // maximum number of total threads in each pool | |
| * ... any extension-specific options... | |
| * ] ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const PoolCounterConf = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration array for the PoolCounter client. | |
| * | |
| * - servers: Array of hostnames, or hostname:port. The default port is 7531. | |
| * - timeout: Connection timeout. | |
| * - connect_timeout: [Since 1.28] Alternative connection timeout. If set, it is used | |
| * instead of `timeout` and will be retried once if a connection fails | |
| * to be established. Background: https://phabricator.wikimedia.org/T105378. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\PoolCounter\PoolCounterClient | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const PoolCountClientConf = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'servers' => [ | |
| '127.0.0.1' | |
| ], | |
| 'timeout' => 0.1, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Max time (in seconds) a user-generated transaction can spend in writes. | |
| * | |
| * If exceeded, the transaction is rolled back with an error instead of being committed. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxUserDBWriteDuration = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Max time (in seconds) a job-generated transaction can spend in writes. | |
| * | |
| * If exceeded, the transaction is rolled back with an error instead of being committed. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.30 | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxJobDBWriteDuration = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * LinkHolderArray batch size | |
| * For debugging | |
| */ | |
| public const LinkHolderBatchSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 1000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of pages to move at once when moving subpages with a page. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaximumMovedPages = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Force deferred updates to be run before sending a response to the client, | |
| * instead of attempting to run them after sending the response. Setting this | |
| * to true is useful for end-to-end testing, to ensure that the effects of a | |
| * request are visible to any subsequent requests, even if they are made | |
| * immediately after the first one. Note however that this does not ensure | |
| * that database replication is complete, nor does it execute any jobs | |
| * enqueued for later. | |
| * There should be no reason to set this in a normal production environment. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const ForceDeferredUpdatesPreSend = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether site_stats table should have multiple rows. If set to true, in each update, | |
| * one of ten rows gets updated at random to reduce lock wait time in wikis | |
| * that have lots of concurrent edits. | |
| * It should be set to true in really large wikis with big flow of edits, | |
| * Otherwise it can cause inaccuracy in data. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const MultiShardSiteStats = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end performance hacks | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Cache settings | |
| /** @name Cache settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Directory for caching data in the local filesystem. Should not be accessible | |
| * from the web. | |
| * | |
| * Note: if multiple wikis share the same localisation cache directory, they | |
| * must all have the same set of extensions. You can set a directory just for | |
| * the localisation cache using $wgLocalisationCacheConf['storeDirectory']. | |
| */ | |
| public const CacheDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Main cache type. This should be a cache with fast access, but it may have | |
| * limited space. By default, it is disabled, since the stock database cache | |
| * is not fast enough to make it worthwhile. | |
| * | |
| * The options are: | |
| * | |
| * - CACHE_ANYTHING: Use anything, as long as it works | |
| * - CACHE_NONE: Do not cache | |
| * - CACHE_DB: Store cache objects in the DB | |
| * - CACHE_MEMCACHED: MemCached, must specify servers in $wgMemCachedServers | |
| * - CACHE_ACCEL: APC or APCu | |
| * - (other): A string may be used which identifies a cache | |
| * configuration in $wgObjectCaches. | |
| * | |
| * For a multi-datacenter setup, the underlying service should be configured | |
| * to broadcast operations by WANObjectCache using Mcrouter or Dynomite. | |
| * See @ref wanobjectcache-deployment "Deploying WANObjectCache". | |
| * To configure the `broadcastRoutingPrefix` WANObjectCache parameter, | |
| * use $wgWANObjectCache. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::MessageCacheType | |
| * @see self::ParserCacheType | |
| */ | |
| public const MainCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_NONE, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The cache type for storing the contents of the MediaWiki namespace. This | |
| * cache is used for a small amount of data which is expensive to regenerate. | |
| * | |
| * For available types see $wgMainCacheType. | |
| */ | |
| public const MessageCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_ANYTHING, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The cache type for storing page content HTML (e.g. parsed from wikitext). | |
| * | |
| * Parsing wikitext is considered an expensive operation. It is recommended | |
| * to give your parser cache plenty of storage space, such that long tail cache | |
| * hits are possible. | |
| * | |
| * The default parser cache backend (when MainCacheType is left to CACHE_NONE) | |
| * is effectively CACHE_DB (SqlBagOStuff). If you set up a main cache type | |
| * such as memcached, it is recommended to set this explicitly to CACHE_DB. | |
| * | |
| * Advice for large wiki farms: | |
| * - Consider allocating a dedicated database to ParserCache. | |
| * Register it in $wgObjectCaches and point $wgParserCacheType to it. | |
| * - Consider using MultiWriteBagOStuff to add a higher tier with Memcached | |
| * in front of the lower database tier. | |
| * - Consider setting `'purgePeriod' => 0` in the dedicated SqlBagOStuff | |
| * entry in $wgObjectCaches. This disables the automatic purging of | |
| * expired rows (which would normally happen in the background of | |
| * write requests). You can then schedule the purgeParserCache.php script | |
| * to e.g. once a day prune expired rows from the a dedicated maintenance | |
| * server. | |
| * | |
| * For available types see $wgMainCacheType. | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_ANYTHING, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The cache backend for storing authenticated session data when $wgAnonSessionCacheType | |
| * is set. Otherwise, when $wgAnonSessionCacheType is unset, this will be used for all types | |
| * of sessions. | |
| * | |
| * Used by MediaWiki\Session\SessionStore. See $wgMainCacheType for available types. | |
| * | |
| * See [SessionStore Storage expectations](@ref SessionStore-storage-expectations). | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_ANYTHING, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The cache backend for storing anonymous session data. When false, $wgSessionCacheType | |
| * will be used. | |
| * | |
| * Used by MediaWiki\Session\SessionCache. See $wgSessionCacheType for available types. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const AnonSessionCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => false | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The cache type for storing language conversion tables, | |
| * which are used when parsing certain text and interface messages. | |
| * | |
| * For available types see $wgMainCacheType. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const LanguageConverterCacheType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_ANYTHING, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Advanced object cache configuration. | |
| * | |
| * Use this to define the class names and constructor parameters which are used | |
| * for the various cache types. Custom cache types may be defined here and | |
| * referenced from $wgMainCacheType, $wgMessageCacheType, $wgParserCacheType, | |
| * or $wgLanguageConverterCacheType. | |
| * | |
| * The format is an associative array where the key is a cache identifier, and | |
| * the value is an associative array of parameters. One of the following | |
| * parameters specifying the class must be given: | |
| * | |
| * - class: The class name which will be used. | |
| * - factory: A callable function which will generate a suitable cache object. | |
| * | |
| * The following parameters are shared and understood by most classes: | |
| * | |
| * - loggroup: The log channel to use. | |
| * | |
| * For SqlBagOStuff, the main configured database will be used, unless one of the following | |
| * three parameters is given: | |
| * | |
| * - server: Server config map for Database::factory() that describes the database to | |
| * use for all key operations in the current region. This is overridden by "servers". | |
| * - servers: Map of tag strings to server config maps, each for Database::factory(), | |
| * describing the set of database servers on which to distribute key operations in the | |
| * current region. Data is distributed among the servers via key hashing based on the | |
| * server tags. Therefore, each tag represents a shard of the dataset. Tags are useful | |
| * for failover using cold-standby servers and for managing shards with replica servers | |
| * in multiple regions (each having different hostnames). | |
| * - cluster: The ExternalStore cluster name to use. | |
| * | |
| * SqlBagOStuff also accepts the following optional parameters: | |
| * | |
| * - dbDomain: The database name to pass to the LoadBalancer. | |
| * - purgePeriod: The average number of object cache writes in between garbage collection | |
| * operations, where expired entries are removed from the database. Or in other words, | |
| * the probability of performing a purge is one in every this number. If set to zero, | |
| * purging will never be done at runtime (for use with PurgeParserCache). | |
| * - purgeLimit: Maximum number of rows to purge at once. | |
| * - tableName: The table name to use, default is "objectcache". | |
| * - shards: The number of tables to use for data storage on each server. If greater than | |
| * 1, table names are formed in the style objectcacheNNN where NNN is the shard index, | |
| * between 0 and shards-1. The number of digits used in the suffix is the minimum number | |
| * required to hold the largest shard index. Data is distributed among the tables via | |
| * key hashing. This helps mitigate MySQL bugs 61735 and 61736. | |
| * - writeBatchSize: Default maximum number of rows to change in each query for write | |
| * operations that can be chunked into a set of smaller writes. | |
| * - dataRedundancy: When set to a number higher than one, instead of sharding values, | |
| * it writes to that many servers (out of all servers) and reads from all of them too. | |
| * In case of inconsistency between servers, it picks the value with the highest exptime. | |
| * Mostly useful for stronger consistency such as mainstash. | |
| * This option has many limitations (for example when TTL is set to indef or changes) | |
| * and it shouldn't be used to handle race conditions nor canonical data. | |
| * The main point of data redundancy is to allow depool of a cluster for maintenance | |
| * without displacing too many keys. | |
| * | |
| * For MemcachedPhpBagOStuff parameters see {@link MemcachedPhpBagOStuff::__construct} | |
| * | |
| * For MemcachedPeclBagOStuff parameters see {@link MemcachedPeclBagOStuff::__construct} | |
| * | |
| * For RedisBagOStuff parameters see {@link Wikimedia\ObjectCache\RedisBagOStuff::__construct} | |
| */ | |
| public const ObjectCaches = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| CACHE_NONE => [ 'class' => EmptyBagOStuff::class, 'reportDupes' => false ], | |
| CACHE_DB => [ 'class' => SqlBagOStuff::class, 'loggroup' => 'SQLBagOStuff' ], | |
| 'memcached-php' => [ 'class' => MemcachedPhpBagOStuff::class, 'loggroup' => 'memcached' ], | |
| 'memcached-pecl' => [ 'class' => MemcachedPeclBagOStuff::class, 'loggroup' => 'memcached' ], | |
| 'hash' => [ 'class' => HashBagOStuff::class, 'reportDupes' => false ], | |
| // Deprecated since 1.35. | |
| // - To configure a wg*CacheType variable to use the local server cache, | |
| // use CACHE_ACCEL instead, which will select these automatically. | |
| // - To access the object for the local server cache at run-time, | |
| // use MediaWikiServices::getLocalServerObjectCache() | |
| // instead of e.g. ObjectCache::getInstance( 'apcu' ). | |
| // - To instantiate a new one of these explicitly, do so directly | |
| // by using `new APCUBagOStuff( [ … ] )` | |
| // - To instantiate a new one of these including auto-detection and fallback, | |
| // use ObjectCache::makeLocalServerCache(). | |
| 'apc' => [ 'class' => APCUBagOStuff::class, 'reportDupes' => false ], | |
| 'apcu' => [ 'class' => APCUBagOStuff::class, 'reportDupes' => false ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Extra parameters to the WANObjectCache constructor. | |
| * | |
| * See @ref wanobjectcache-deployment "Deploying WANObjectCache". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.40 | |
| */ | |
| public const WANObjectCache = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The stash store backend for MicroStash. | |
| * | |
| * This store should be optimized for ephemeral data, and should be able to handle | |
| * a high volume of writes and reads. The dataset access scope should be across | |
| * all servers that serve the application. | |
| * | |
| * Note that the TTL of the data written to this store must be respected completely | |
| * before the data gets evicted from the store (whether the data is used or not). | |
| * The store must not evict data based on LRU or popularity before the TTL expires. | |
| * | |
| * Expectations for sysadmins: | |
| * | |
| * 1. The data written to this store is generally short-lived (seconds/minutes), | |
| * 2. This store must reliably persist and should not evict data until the TTL expires, | |
| * 3. The same store must be accessed by all application servers (i.e. no visible lag or | |
| * split reality), | |
| * 4. This store should handle a high volume of both writes and reads, | |
| * with reads completing with consistently low latencies. | |
| * | |
| * Examples users: | |
| * | |
| * - {@link MediaWiki::Permissions::RateLimiter RateLimiter} (via RStatsFactory) | |
| * - {@link Wikimedia::Rdbms::ChronologyProtector ChronologyProtector} | |
| * See also [ChronologyProtector requirements](@ref ChronologyProtector-storage-requirements), | |
| * for more detailed system administrator requirements for multi-DC operations. | |
| * | |
| * Valid options are the keys of {@link $wgObjectCaches}, e.g. CACHE_* constants. | |
| * | |
| * @see \Wikimedia\ObjectCache\BagOStuff | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const MicroStashType = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_ANYTHING, | |
| 'type' => 'string|int', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The object store type of the main stash. | |
| * | |
| * This should be a fast storage system optimized for lightweight data, both ephemeral and | |
| * permanent, for things like counters, tokens, and blobs. The dataset access scope should | |
| * include all the application servers in all datacenters. Thus, the data must be replicated | |
| * among all datacenters. The store should have "Last Write Wins" eventual consistency. Per | |
| * https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/PACELC_theorem, the store should act as a PA/EL distributed | |
| * system for these operations. | |
| * | |
| * The multi-datacenter strategy for MediaWiki is to have CDN route HTTP POST requests to the | |
| * primary datacenter and HTTP GET/HEAD/OPTIONS requests to the closest datacenter to the | |
| * client. The stash accepts write operations from any datacenter, but cross-datacenter | |
| * replication is asynchronous. | |
| * | |
| * Modules that use the main stash can expect race conditions to occur if a key can receive | |
| * write operations originating from multiple datacenters. To improve consistency, callers | |
| * should avoid main stash updates during non-POST requests. In any case, callers should | |
| * gracefully tolerate occasional key evictions, temporary inconsistencies among datacenters, | |
| * and violations of linearizability (e.g. during timeouts). Modules that can never handle | |
| * these kinds of anomalies should use other storage mediums. | |
| * | |
| * Valid options are the keys of {@link $wgObjectCaches}, e.g. CACHE_* constants. | |
| * | |
| * @see \Wikimedia\ObjectCache\BagOStuff | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const MainStash = [ | |
| 'default' => CACHE_DB, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for the caching related to parsoid output. The configuration contains the | |
| * following keys: | |
| * | |
| * - StashType: The type of object store to be used by the ParsoidOutputStash service, | |
| * which stores the base state of HTML based edits. | |
| * Valid options are the keys of {@link $wgObjectCaches}, e.g. CACHE_* constants. | |
| * By default, the value of the MainStash setting will be used. | |
| * This should be an object store that provides fairly solid persistence guarantees, | |
| * since losing an entry from the stash may mean that the user can't save their edit. | |
| * If null, the value of the MainStash configuration setting will be used. | |
| * | |
| * - StashDuration: The number of seconds for which an entry in the stash should be kept. | |
| * Should be long enough for users to finish editing, | |
| * since losing an entry from the stash may mean that the user can't save their edit. | |
| * This is set to one day by default. | |
| * | |
| * - WarmParsoidParserCache: Setting this to true will pre-populate the parsoid parser cache | |
| * with parsoid outputs on page edits. This speeds up loading HTML into Visual Editor. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| * @unstable Per MediaWiki 1.39, the structure of this configuration is still subject to | |
| * change. | |
| */ | |
| public const ParsoidCacheConfig = [ | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| 'properties' => [ | |
| 'StashType' => [ 'type' => 'int|string|null', 'default' => null ], | |
| 'StashDuration' => [ 'type' => 'int', 'default' => 24 * 60 * 60 ], | |
| 'WarmParsoidParserCache' => [ 'type' => 'bool', 'default' => false ], | |
| ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Sample rate for collecting statistics on Parsoid selective update. | |
| * | |
| * Zero disables collection; 1000 means "1 in every 1000 parses will | |
| * be sampled". | |
| * | |
| * @warning This is EXPERIMENTAL and will disappear once analysis is | |
| * complete. | |
| */ | |
| public const ParsoidSelectiveUpdateSampleRate = [ | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Per-namespace configuration for the ParserCache filter. | |
| * | |
| * There is one top level key for each cache name supported in ParserCacheFactory. | |
| * The per-namespace configuration is given separately for each cache. | |
| * | |
| * For each namespace, this defines a set of filter options, which are represented | |
| * as an associative array. The following keys are supported in this array: | |
| * | |
| * - minCpuTime: causes the parser cache to not save any output that took fewer | |
| * than the given number of seconds of CPU time to generate, according to | |
| * ParserOutput::getTimeProfile(). Set to 0 to always cache, or to | |
| * PHP_INT_MAX to disable caching for this namespace. | |
| * | |
| * If no filter options are defined for a given namespace, the filter options | |
| * under the "default" key will be used for pages in that namespace. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserCacheFilterConfig = [ | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'default' => [ // default value | |
| 'pcache' => [ // old parser cache | |
| 'default' => [ // all namespaces | |
| // 0 means no threshold. | |
| // Use PHP_INT_MAX to disable cache. | |
| 'minCpuTime' => 0 | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'parsoid-pcache' => [ // parsoid output cache | |
| 'default' => [ // all namespaces | |
| // 0 means no threshold. | |
| // Use PHP_INT_MAX to disable cache. | |
| 'minCpuTime' => 0 | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ // caches | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'description' => 'A map of namespace IDs to filter definitions.', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ // namespaces | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'description' => 'A map of filter names to values.', | |
| 'properties' => [ // filters | |
| 'minCpuTime' => [ 'type' => 'float' ] | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Secret string for HMAC hashing in ChronologyProtector [optional] | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const ChronologyProtectorSecret = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The expiry time for the parser cache, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * The default is 86400 (one day). | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserCacheExpireTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 60 * 60 * 24, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The expiry time for "not ready" asynchronous content in the parser | |
| * cache, in seconds. This should be rather short, to allow the | |
| * "not ready" content to be replaced by "ready" content. | |
| * | |
| * The default is 60 (one minute). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.44 | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserCacheAsyncExpireTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to re-run the refresh links jobs when asynchronous content | |
| * becomes ready. This is needed if the asynchronous content can affect | |
| * categories or other page metadata. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.44 | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserCacheAsyncRefreshJobs = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The expiry time for the parser cache for old revisions, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * The default is 3600 (cache disabled). | |
| */ | |
| public const OldRevisionParserCacheExpireTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 60 * 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The expiry time to use for session storage, in seconds. | |
| */ | |
| public const ObjectCacheSessionExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 60 * 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use PHP session handling ($_SESSION and session_*() functions) | |
| * | |
| * If the constant MW_NO_SESSION is defined, this is forced to 'disable'. | |
| * | |
| * If the constant MW_NO_SESSION_HANDLER is defined, this is ignored and PHP | |
| * session handling will function independently of SessionHandler. | |
| * SessionHandler and PHP's session handling may attempt to override each | |
| * others' cookies. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| * @deprecated since 1.45 Integration with PHP session handling will be removed in the future | |
| */ | |
| public const PHPSessionHandling = [ | |
| 'default' => 'warn', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.45 Integration with PHP session handling will be removed in the future', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Time in seconds to remember IPs for, for the purposes of logging IP changes within the | |
| * same session. This is meant more for debugging errors in the authentication system than | |
| * for detecting abuse. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const SuspiciousIpExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of internal PBKDF2 iterations to use when deriving session secrets. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.28 | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionPbkdf2Iterations = [ | |
| 'default' => 10001, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Include a JWT alongside the session cookie when using cookie-based sessions. | |
| * | |
| * @note The JWT cookie intentionally has the same name on all wikis, to make it easier for | |
| * edge infrastructure to handle it. If multiple wikis use the same domain, without | |
| * appropriate $wgCookieDomain settings, enabling this will break session handling. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| * @see SessionManager::getJwtData() | |
| */ | |
| public const UseSessionCookieJwt = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The list of MemCached servers and port numbers | |
| */ | |
| public const MemCachedServers = [ | |
| 'default' => [ '127.0.0.1:11211', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use persistent connections to MemCached, which are shared across multiple | |
| * requests. | |
| */ | |
| public const MemCachedPersistent = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Read/write timeout for MemCached server communication, in microseconds. | |
| */ | |
| public const MemCachedTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 500_000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true to maintain a copy of the message cache on the local server. | |
| * | |
| * This layer of message cache is in addition to the one configured by $wgMessageCacheType. | |
| * | |
| * The local copy is put in APC. If APC is not installed, this setting does nothing. | |
| * | |
| * Note that this is about the message cache, which stores interface messages | |
| * maintained as wiki pages. This is separate from the localisation cache for interface | |
| * messages provided by the software, which is configured by $wgLocalisationCacheConf. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseLocalMessageCache = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Instead of caching everything, only cache those messages which have | |
| * been customised in the site content language. This means that | |
| * MediaWiki:Foo/ja is ignored if MediaWiki:Foo doesn't exist. | |
| * | |
| * This option is probably only useful for translatewiki.net. | |
| */ | |
| public const AdaptiveMessageCache = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Localisation cache configuration. | |
| * | |
| * Used by service wiring to decide how to construct the | |
| * LocalisationCache instance. Associative array with keys: | |
| * | |
| * class: The class to use for constructing the LocalisationCache object. | |
| * This may be overridden by extensions to a subclass of LocalisationCache. | |
| * Sub classes are expected to still honor the 'storeClass', 'storeDirectory' | |
| * and 'manualRecache' options where applicable. | |
| * | |
| * storeClass: Which LCStore class implementation to use. This is optional. | |
| * The default LocalisationCache class offers the 'store' option | |
| * as abstraction for this. | |
| * | |
| * store: How and where to store localisation cache data. | |
| * This option is ignored if 'storeClass' is explicitly set to a class name. | |
| * Must be one of: | |
| * - 'detect' (default): Automatically select 'files' if 'storeDirectory' | |
| * or $wgCacheDirectory is set, and fall back to 'db' otherwise. | |
| * - 'files': Store in $wgCacheDirectory as CDB files. | |
| * - 'array': Store in $wgCacheDirectory as PHP static array files. | |
| * - 'db': Store in the l10n_cache database table. | |
| * | |
| * storeDirectory: If the selected LCStore class puts its data in files, then it | |
| * will use this directory. If set to false (default), then | |
| * $wgCacheDirectory is used instead. | |
| * | |
| * manualRecache: Set this to true to disable cache updates on web requests. | |
| * Use maintenance/rebuildLocalisationCache.php instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalisationCacheConf = [ | |
| 'properties' => [ | |
| 'class' => [ 'type' => 'string', 'default' => LocalisationCache::class ], | |
| 'store' => [ 'type' => 'string', 'default' => 'detect' ], | |
| 'storeClass' => [ 'type' => 'false|string', 'default' => false ], | |
| 'storeDirectory' => [ 'type' => 'false|string', 'default' => false ], | |
| 'storeServer' => [ 'type' => 'object', 'default' => [] ], | |
| 'forceRecache' => [ 'type' => 'bool', 'default' => false ], | |
| 'manualRecache' => [ 'type' => 'bool', 'default' => false ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow client-side caching of pages | |
| */ | |
| public const CachePages = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to current time to invalidate all prior cached pages. Affects both | |
| * client-side and server-side caching. | |
| * | |
| * You can get the current date on your server by using the command: | |
| * | |
| * @verbatim date +%Y%m%d%H%M%S | |
| * @endverbatim | |
| */ | |
| public const CacheEpoch = [ | |
| 'default' => '20030516000000', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Directory where GitInfo will look for pre-computed cache files. If false, | |
| * $wgCacheDirectory/gitinfo will be used. | |
| */ | |
| public const GitInfoCacheDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This will cache static pages for non-logged-in users to reduce | |
| * database traffic on public sites. ResourceLoader requests to default | |
| * language and skins are cached as well as single module requests. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseFileCache = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Depth of the subdirectory hierarchy to be created under | |
| * $wgFileCacheDirectory. The subdirectories will be named based on | |
| * the MD5 hash of the title. A value of 0 means all cache files will | |
| * be put directly into the main file cache directory. | |
| */ | |
| public const FileCacheDepth = [ | |
| 'default' => 2, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Append a configured value to the parser cache and the sitenotice key so | |
| * that they can be kept separate for some class of activity. | |
| */ | |
| public const RenderHashAppend = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If on, the sidebar navigation links are cached for users with the | |
| * current language set. This can save a touch of load on a busy site | |
| * by shaving off extra message lookups. | |
| * | |
| * However it is also fragile: changing the site configuration, or | |
| * having a variable $wgArticlePath, can produce broken links that | |
| * don't update as expected. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableSidebarCache = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expiry time for the sidebar cache, in seconds | |
| */ | |
| public const SidebarCacheExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 86400, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When using the file cache, we can store the cached HTML gzipped to save disk | |
| * space. Pages will then also be served compressed to clients that support it. | |
| * | |
| * Requires zlib support enabled in PHP. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseGzip = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Invalidate various caches when LocalSettings.php changes. This is equivalent | |
| * to setting $wgCacheEpoch to the modification time of LocalSettings.php, as | |
| * was previously done in the default LocalSettings.php file. | |
| * | |
| * On high-traffic wikis, this should be set to false, to avoid the need to | |
| * check the file modification time, and to avoid the performance impact of | |
| * unnecessary cache invalidations. | |
| */ | |
| public const InvalidateCacheOnLocalSettingsChange = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When loading extensions through the extension registration system, this | |
| * can be used to invalidate the cache. A good idea would be to set this to | |
| * one file, you can just `touch` that one to invalidate the cache | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExtensionInfoMTime = filemtime( "$IP/LocalSettings.php" ); | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * If set to false, the mtime for each individual JSON file will be checked, | |
| * which can be slow if a large number of extensions are being loaded. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionInfoMTime = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is set to true, phpunit will run integration tests against remote | |
| * caches defined in $wgObjectCaches. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableRemoteBagOStuffTests = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of cache settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region HTTP proxy (CDN) settings | |
| /** @name HTTP proxy (CDN) settings | |
| * | |
| * Many of these settings apply to any HTTP proxy used in front of MediaWiki, | |
| * although they are sometimes still referred to as Squid settings for | |
| * historical reasons. | |
| * | |
| * Achieving a high hit ratio with an HTTP proxy requires special configuration. | |
| * See https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Performance_tuning#Page_view_caching | |
| * for more details. | |
| */ | |
| /** | |
| * Enable/disable CDN. | |
| * | |
| * See https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Performance_tuning#Page_view_caching | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 Renamed from $wgUseSquid. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseCdn = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Add X-Forwarded-Proto to the Vary and Key headers for API requests and | |
| * RSS/Atom feeds. Use this if you have an SSL termination setup | |
| * and need to split the cache between HTTP and HTTPS for API requests, | |
| * feed requests and HTTP redirect responses in order to prevent cache | |
| * pollution. This does not affect 'normal' requests to index.php other than | |
| * HTTP redirects. | |
| */ | |
| public const VaryOnXFP = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Internal server name as known to CDN, if different. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgInternalServer = 'http://yourinternal.tld:8000'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const InternalServer = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cache TTL for the CDN sent as s-maxage (without ESI) or | |
| * Surrogate-Control (with ESI). Without ESI, you should strip | |
| * out s-maxage in the CDN config. | |
| * | |
| * 18000 seconds = 5 hours, more cache hits with 2678400 = 31 days. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 Renamed from $wgSquidMaxage | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnMaxAge = [ | |
| 'default' => 18000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cache timeout for the CDN when DB replica DB lag is high | |
| * | |
| * @see self::CdnMaxAge | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnMaxageLagged = [ | |
| 'default' => 30, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cache timeout when delivering a stale ParserCache response due to PoolCounter | |
| * contention. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnMaxageStale = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set, any SquidPurge call on a URL or URLs will send a second purge no less than | |
| * this many seconds later via the job queue. This requires delayed job support. | |
| * | |
| * This should be safely higher than the 'max lag' value in $wgLBFactoryConf, so that | |
| * replica DB lag does not cause page to be stuck in stales states in CDN. | |
| * | |
| * This also fixes race conditions in two-tiered CDN setups (e.g. cdn2 => cdn1 => MediaWiki). | |
| * If a purge for a URL reaches cdn2 before cdn1 and a request reaches cdn2 for that URL, | |
| * it will populate the response from the stale cdn1 value. When cdn1 gets the purge, cdn2 | |
| * will still be stale. If the rebound purge delay is safely higher than the time to relay | |
| * a purge to all nodes, then the rebound purge will clear cdn2 after cdn1 was cleared. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnReboundPurgeDelay = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cache timeout for the CDN when a response is known to be wrong or incomplete (due to load) | |
| * | |
| * @see self::CdnMaxAge | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnMaxageSubstitute = [ | |
| 'default' => 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default maximum age for raw CSS/JS accesses | |
| * | |
| * 300 seconds = 5 minutes. | |
| */ | |
| public const ForcedRawSMaxage = [ | |
| 'default' => 300, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of proxy servers to purge on changes; default port is 80. Use IP addresses. | |
| * | |
| * When MediaWiki is running behind a proxy, it will trust X-Forwarded-For | |
| * headers sent/modified from these proxies when obtaining the remote IP address | |
| * | |
| * For a list of trusted servers which *aren't* purged, see $wgSquidServersNoPurge. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 Renamed from $wgSquidServers. | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnServers = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * As with $wgCdnServers, except these servers aren't purged on page changes; | |
| * use to set a list of trusted proxies, etc. Supports both individual IP | |
| * addresses and CIDR blocks. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 Supports CIDR ranges | |
| * @since 1.34 Renamed from $wgSquidServersNoPurge | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnServersNoPurge = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Routing configuration for HTCP multicast purging. Add elements here to | |
| * enable HTCP and determine which purges are sent where. If set to an empty | |
| * array, HTCP is disabled. | |
| * | |
| * Each key in this array is a regular expression to match against the purged | |
| * URL, or an empty string to match all URLs. The purged URL is matched against | |
| * the regexes in the order specified, and the first rule whose regex matches | |
| * is used, all remaining rules will thus be ignored. | |
| * | |
| * **Example configuration to send purges for upload.wikimedia.org to one** | |
| * multicast group and all other purges to another: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgHTCPRouting = [ | |
| * '|^https?://upload\.wikimedia\.org|' => [ | |
| * 'host' => '239.128.0.113', | |
| * 'port' => 4827, | |
| * ], | |
| * '' => [ | |
| * 'host' => '239.128.0.112', | |
| * 'port' => 4827, | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * You can also pass an array of hosts to send purges too. This is useful when | |
| * you have several multicast groups or unicast address that should receive a | |
| * given purge. Multiple hosts support was introduced in MediaWiki 1.22. | |
| * | |
| * **Example of sending purges to multiple hosts:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgHTCPRouting = [ | |
| * '' => [ | |
| * // Purges to text caches using multicast | |
| * [ 'host' => '239.128.0.114', 'port' => '4827' ], | |
| * // Purges to a hardcoded list of caches | |
| * [ 'host' => '10.88.66.1', 'port' => '4827' ], | |
| * [ 'host' => '10.88.66.2', 'port' => '4827' ], | |
| * [ 'host' => '10.88.66.3', 'port' => '4827' ], | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| * @see self::HTCPMulticastTTL | |
| */ | |
| public const HTCPRouting = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * HTCP multicast TTL. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::HTCPRouting | |
| */ | |
| public const HTCPMulticastTTL = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Should forwarded Private IPs be accepted? | |
| */ | |
| public const UsePrivateIPs = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to false if MediaWiki is behind a CDN that re-orders query | |
| * parameters on incoming requests. | |
| * | |
| * MediaWiki sets a large 'Cache-Control: s-maxage=' directive on page | |
| * views only if the request URL matches one of the normal CDN URL forms. | |
| * When 'CdnMatchParameterOrder' is false, the matching algorithm ignores | |
| * the order of URL parameters. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const CdnMatchParameterOrder = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of HTTP proxy settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Language, regional and character encoding settings | |
| /** @name Language, regional and character encoding settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Site language code. See includes/languages/data/Names.php for languages | |
| * supported by MediaWiki out of the box. Not all languages listed there have | |
| * translations, see languages/messages/ for the list of languages with some | |
| * localisation. | |
| * | |
| * Warning: Don't use any of MediaWiki's deprecated language codes listed in | |
| * LanguageCode::getDeprecatedCodeMapping or $wgDummyLanguageCodes, like "no" | |
| * for Norwegian (use "nb" instead). If you do, things will break unexpectedly. | |
| * | |
| * This defines the default interface language for all users, but users can | |
| * change it in their preferences. | |
| * | |
| * This also defines the language of pages in the wiki. The content is wrapped | |
| * in a html element with lang=XX attribute. This behavior can be overridden | |
| * via hooks, see Title::getPageLanguage. | |
| */ | |
| public const LanguageCode = [ | |
| 'default' => 'en', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Some languages need different word forms, usually for different cases. | |
| * | |
| * Used in Language::convertGrammar(). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgGrammarForms['en']['genitive']['car'] = 'car\'s'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const GrammarForms = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Treat language links as magic connectors, not inline links | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiMagic = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Hide interlanguage links from the sidebar | |
| */ | |
| public const HideInterlanguageLinks = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of additional interwiki prefixes that should be treated as | |
| * interlanguage links (i.e. placed in the sidebar). | |
| * | |
| * Notes: | |
| * - This will not do anything unless the prefixes are defined in the interwiki | |
| * map. | |
| * - The display text for these custom interlanguage links will be fetched from | |
| * the system message "interlanguage-link-xyz" where xyz is the prefix in | |
| * this array. | |
| * - A friendly name for each site, used for tooltip text, may optionally be | |
| * placed in the system message "interlanguage-link-sitename-xyz" where xyz is | |
| * the prefix in this array. | |
| * - This should be a list of "interwiki prefixes" (ie, what appears in | |
| * wikitext), and you probably want to add an entry to | |
| * InterlanguageLinkCodeMap as well to specify which mediawiki internal | |
| * (or custom) language code this prefix corresponds to, and perhaps | |
| * then map that custom language code to a language name in | |
| * ExtraLanguageNames. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraInterlanguageLinkPrefixes = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map of interlanguage link codes to language codes. This is useful to override | |
| * what is shown as the language name when the interwiki code does not match it | |
| * exactly | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const InterlanguageLinkCodeMap = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of language names or overrides for default names in Names.php | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraLanguageNames = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of mappings from one language code to another. | |
| * | |
| * This array makes the codes not appear as a selectable language on the | |
| * installer. | |
| * | |
| * In Setup.php, the variable $wgDummyLanguageCodes is created by combining | |
| * these codes with a list of "deprecated" codes, which are mostly leftovers | |
| * from renames or other legacy things, and the internal codes 'qqq' and 'qqx'. | |
| * If a mapping in $wgExtraLanguageCodes collide with a built-in mapping, the | |
| * value in $wgExtraLanguageCodes will be used. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.29 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraLanguageCodes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'bh' => 'bho', | |
| 'no' => 'nb', | |
| 'simple' => 'en', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Functionally the same as $wgExtraLanguageCodes, but deprecated. Instead of | |
| * appending values to this array, append them to $wgExtraLanguageCodes. | |
| * | |
| * @note Since 1.29, this should not be set directly in LocalSettings, | |
| * ExtraLanguageCodes should be set instead. However, DummyLanguageCodes | |
| * will be initialized and can be read internally. | |
| */ | |
| public const DummyLanguageCodes = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to always convert certain Unicode sequences to modern ones | |
| * regardless of the content language. This has a small performance | |
| * impact. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const AllUnicodeFixes = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to eg 'ISO-8859-1' to perform character set conversion when | |
| * loading old revisions not marked with "utf-8" flag. Use this when | |
| * converting a wiki from MediaWiki 1.4 or earlier to UTF-8 without the | |
| * burdensome mass conversion of old text data. | |
| * | |
| * @note This DOES NOT touch any fields other than old_text. Titles, comments, | |
| * user names, etc still must be converted en masse in the database before | |
| * continuing as a UTF-8 wiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const LegacyEncoding = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable dates like 'May 12' instead of '12 May', if the default date format | |
| * is 'dmy or mdy'. | |
| */ | |
| public const AmericanDates = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * For Hindi and Arabic use local numerals instead of Western style (0-9) | |
| * numerals in interface. | |
| */ | |
| public const TranslateNumerals = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Translation using MediaWiki: namespace. | |
| * | |
| * Interface messages will be loaded from the database. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseDatabaseMessages = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum entry size in the message cache, in bytes | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxMsgCacheEntrySize = [ | |
| 'default' => 10000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable language variant conversion. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableLangConversion = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable language variant conversion for links. | |
| * Note that this option is slightly misnamed. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableTitleConversion = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default variant code. If false, the default will be the static default | |
| * variant of the language. | |
| */ | |
| public const DefaultLanguageVariant = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable the pig Latin variant of English (en-x-piglatin), | |
| * used to ease variant development work. | |
| */ | |
| public const UsePigLatinVariant = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disabled variants array of language variant conversion. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDisabledVariants[] = 'zh-mo'; | |
| * $wgDisabledVariants[] = 'zh-my'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const DisabledVariants = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Like $wgArticlePath, but on multi-variant wikis, this provides a | |
| * path format that describes which parts of the URL contain the | |
| * language variant. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgLanguageCode = 'sr'; | |
| * $wgVariantArticlePath = '/$2/$1'; | |
| * $wgArticlePath = '/wiki/$1'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * A link to /wiki/ would be redirected to /sr/Главна_страна | |
| * | |
| * It is important that $wgArticlePath not overlap with possible values | |
| * of $wgVariantArticlePath. | |
| */ | |
| public const VariantArticlePath = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable the 'x-xss' language code, used for development. | |
| * | |
| * When enabled, the language code 'x-xss' (e.g. via ?uselang=x-xss) can | |
| * be used to test correct message escaping at scale, to prevent | |
| * cross-site scripting. In this "language", every message becomes an HTML | |
| * snippet which attempts to alert the message key. Well-written code will | |
| * correctly escape all of these messages. If any alerts are actually | |
| * fired in the browser, the message is not being escaped correctly; | |
| * either the offending code should be fixed, or the message should be | |
| * added to {@link self::RawHtmlMessages}. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Special:MyLanguage/Cross-site_scripting | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseXssLanguage = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show a bar of language selection links in the user login and user | |
| * registration forms; edit the "loginlanguagelinks" message to | |
| * customise these. | |
| */ | |
| public const LoginLanguageSelector = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When translating messages with wfMessage(), it is not always clear what | |
| * should be considered UI messages and what should be content messages. | |
| * | |
| * For example, for the English Wikipedia, there should be only one 'mainpage', | |
| * so when getting the link for 'mainpage', we should treat it as site content | |
| * and call ->inContentLanguage()->text(), but for rendering the text of the | |
| * link, we call ->text(). The code behaves this way by default. However, | |
| * sites like the Wikimedia Commons do offer different versions of 'mainpage' | |
| * and the like for different languages. This array provides a way to override | |
| * the default behavior. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * To allow language-specific main page and community | |
| * portal: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgForceUIMsgAsContentMsg = [ 'mainpage', 'portal-url' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ForceUIMsgAsContentMsg = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of messages which might contain raw HTML. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions should add their insecure raw HTML messages to extension.json. | |
| * The list is used for access control: | |
| * changing messages listed here will require editsitecss and editsitejs rights. | |
| * | |
| * Message names must be given with underscores rather than spaces and with lowercase first | |
| * letter. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| */ | |
| public const RawHtmlMessages = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Fake out the timezone that the server thinks it's in. This will be used for | |
| * date display and not for what's stored in the DB. Leave to null to retain | |
| * your server's OS-based timezone value. | |
| * | |
| * This variable is currently used only for signature formatting and for local | |
| * time/date parser variables ({{LOCALTIME}} etc.) | |
| * | |
| * Timezones can be translated by editing MediaWiki messages of type | |
| * timezone-nameinlowercase like timezone-utc. | |
| * | |
| * A list of usable timezones can found at: | |
| * https://www.php.net/manual/en/timezones.php | |
| * | |
| * **Examples:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgLocaltimezone = 'UTC'; | |
| * $wgLocaltimezone = 'GMT'; | |
| * $wgLocaltimezone = 'PST8PDT'; | |
| * $wgLocaltimezone = 'Europe/Sweden'; | |
| * $wgLocaltimezone = 'CET'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const Localtimezone = [ | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultLocaltimezone(): string { | |
| // This defaults to the `date.timezone` value of the PHP INI option. If this option is not set, | |
| // it falls back to UTC. | |
| $localtimezone = date_default_timezone_get(); | |
| if ( !$localtimezone ) { | |
| // Make doubly sure we have a valid time zone, even if date_default_timezone_get() | |
| // returned garbage. | |
| $localtimezone = 'UTC'; | |
| } | |
| return $localtimezone; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Set an offset from UTC in minutes to use for the default timezone setting | |
| * for anonymous users and new user accounts. | |
| * | |
| * This setting is used for most date/time displays in the software, and is | |
| * overridable in user preferences. It is *not* used for signature timestamps. | |
| * | |
| * By default, this will be set to match $wgLocaltimezone. | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalTZoffset = [ | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'Localtimezone' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultLocalTZoffset( ?string $localtimezone ): int { | |
| // NOTE: Extra fallback, in case $localtimezone is ''. | |
| // Many extsing LocalSettings files have $wgLocaltimezone = '' | |
| // in them, erroneously generated by the installer. | |
| $localtimezone = $localtimezone ?: self::getDefaultLocaltimezone(); | |
| try { | |
| $timezone = new DateTimeZone( $localtimezone ); | |
| } catch ( \Exception $e ) { | |
| throw new ConfigException( | |
| sprintf( "Invalid timezone '%s'. Please set a valid timezone in '$%s' in LocalSettings.php. Refer to the list of valid timezones at https://www.php.net/timezones. Error: %s", | |
| $localtimezone, | |
| "wgLocaltimezone", | |
| $e->getMessage() ), | |
| ); | |
| } | |
| $offset = $timezone->getOffset( new DateTime() ); | |
| return (int)( $offset / 60 ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Map of Unicode characters for which capitalization is overridden in | |
| * Language::ucfirst. The characters should be | |
| * represented as char_to_convert => conversion_override. See T219279 for details | |
| * on why this is useful during php version transitions. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const OverrideUcfirstCharacters = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of language/charset settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Output format and skin settings | |
| /** @name Output format and skin settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * The default Content-Type header. | |
| */ | |
| public const MimeType = [ | |
| 'default' => 'text/html', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Defines the value of the version attribute in the <html> tag, if any. | |
| * | |
| * If your wiki uses RDFa, set it to the correct value for RDFa+HTML5. | |
| * Correct current values are 'HTML+RDFa 1.0' or 'XHTML+RDFa 1.0'. | |
| * See also https://www.w3.org/TR/rdfa-in-html/#document-conformance | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const Html5Version = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to label the store-to-database-and-show-to-others button in the editor | |
| * as "Save page"/"Save changes" if false (the default) or, if true, instead as | |
| * "Publish page"/"Publish changes". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.28 | |
| */ | |
| public const EditSubmitButtonLabelPublish = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Permit other namespaces in addition to the w3.org default. | |
| * | |
| * Use the prefix for the key and the namespace for the value. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgXhtmlNamespaces['svg'] = 'http://www.w3.org/2000/svg'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Normally we wouldn't have to define this in the root "<html>" | |
| * element, but IE needs it there in some circumstances. | |
| * | |
| * This is ignored if $wgMimeType is set to a non-XML MIME type. | |
| */ | |
| public const XhtmlNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Site notice shown at the top of each page | |
| * | |
| * MediaWiki:Sitenotice page, which will override this. You can also | |
| * provide a separate message for logged-out users using the | |
| * MediaWiki:Anonnotice page. | |
| */ | |
| public const SiteNotice = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Override the ability of certain browsers to attempt to autodetect dataformats in pages. | |
| * | |
| * This is a default feature of many mobile browsers, but can have a lot of false positives, | |
| * where for instance, year ranges are confused with phone numbers. | |
| * The default of this setting is to disable telephone number data detection. | |
| * Set BrowserFormatDetection to false to fallback to the browser defaults. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37 | |
| * @see https://developer.apple.com/library/archive/documentation/AppleApplications/Reference/SafariHTMLRef/Articles/MetaTags.html | |
| */ | |
| public const BrowserFormatDetection = [ | |
| 'default' => 'telephone=no', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * An array of open graph tags which should be added by all skins. | |
| * | |
| * Accepted values are "og:site_name", "og:title", "og:type" and "twitter:card". | |
| * Since some of these fields can be provided by extensions it defaults to an empty array. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const SkinMetaTags = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default skin, for new users and anonymous visitors. Registered users may | |
| * change this to any one of the other available skins in their preferences. | |
| */ | |
| public const DefaultSkin = [ | |
| 'default' => 'vector-2022', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Fallback skin used when the skin defined by $wgDefaultSkin can't be found. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const FallbackSkin = [ | |
| 'default' => 'fallback', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Specify the names of skins that should not be presented in the list of | |
| * available skins in user preferences. | |
| * | |
| * NOTE: This does not uninstall the skin, and it will still be accessible | |
| * via the `useskin` query parameter. To uninstall a skin, remove its inclusion | |
| * from LocalSettings.php. | |
| * | |
| * @see \SkinFactory::getAllowedSkins | |
| */ | |
| public const SkipSkins = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable output compression (enabled by default if zlib is available) | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableOutputCompression = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * How should section IDs be encoded? | |
| * This array can contain 1 or 2 elements, each of them can be one of: | |
| * - 'html5' is modern HTML5 style encoding with minimal escaping. Displays Unicode | |
| * characters in most browsers' address bars. | |
| * | |
| * - 'legacy' is old MediaWiki-style encoding, e.g. 啤酒 turns into .E5.95.A4.E9.85.92 | |
| * | |
| * The first element of this array specifies the primary mode of escaping IDs. This | |
| * is what users will see when they e.g. follow an [[#internal link]] to a section of | |
| * a page. | |
| * | |
| * The optional second element defines a fallback mode, useful for migrations. | |
| * If present, it will direct MediaWiki to add empty <span>s to every section with its | |
| * id attribute set to fallback encoded title so that links using the previous encoding | |
| * would still work. | |
| * | |
| * Example: you want to migrate your wiki from 'legacy' to 'html5' | |
| * | |
| * On the first step, set this variable to [ 'legacy', 'html5' ]. After a while, when | |
| * all caches (parser, HTTP, etc.) contain only pages generated with this setting, | |
| * flip the value to [ 'html5', 'legacy' ]. This will result in all internal links being | |
| * generated in the new encoding while old links (both external and cached internal) will | |
| * still work. After a long time, you might want to ditch backwards compatibility and | |
| * set it to [ 'html5' ]. After all, pages get edited, breaking incoming links no matter which | |
| * fragment mode is used. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.30 | |
| */ | |
| public const FragmentMode = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'html5', 'legacy', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Which ID escaping mode should be used for external interwiki links? See documentation | |
| * for $wgFragmentMode above for details of each mode. Because you can't control external sites, | |
| * this setting should probably always be 'legacy', unless every wiki you link to has converted | |
| * to 'html5'. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.30 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalInterwikiFragmentMode = [ | |
| 'default' => 'legacy', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Abstract list of footer icons for skins in place of old copyrightico and poweredbyico code | |
| * You can add new icons to the built in copyright or poweredby, or you can create | |
| * a new block. Though note that you may need to add some custom css to get good styling | |
| * of new blocks in monobook. vector and modern should work without any special css. | |
| * | |
| * $wgFooterIcons itself is a key/value array. | |
| * The key is the name of a block that the icons will be wrapped in. The final id varies | |
| * by skin; Monobook and Vector will turn poweredby into f-poweredbyico while Modern | |
| * turns it into mw_poweredby. | |
| * The value is either key/value array of icons or a string. | |
| * In the key/value array the key may or may not be used by the skin but it can | |
| * be used to find the icon and unset it or change the icon if needed. | |
| * This is useful for disabling icons that are set by extensions. | |
| * The value should be either a string or an array. If it is a string it will be output | |
| * directly as html, however some skins may choose to ignore it. An array is the preferred | |
| * format for the icon, the following keys are used: | |
| * - src: An absolute url to the image to use for the icon, this is recommended | |
| * but not required, however some skins will ignore icons without an image | |
| * - srcset: optional additional-resolution images; see HTML5 specs | |
| * - url: The url to use in the a element around the text or icon, if not set an a element will | |
| * not be outputted | |
| * - alt: This is the text form of the icon, it will be displayed without an image in | |
| * skins like Modern or if src is not set, and will otherwise be used as | |
| * the alt="" for the image. This key is required. | |
| * - width and height: If the icon specified by src is not of the standard size | |
| * you can specify the size of image to use with these keys. | |
| * Otherwise they will default to the standard 88x31. | |
| * | |
| * @todo Reformat documentation. | |
| */ | |
| public const FooterIcons = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| "copyright" => [ | |
| "copyright" => [], // placeholder for the built in copyright icon | |
| ], | |
| "poweredby" => [ | |
| "mediawiki" => [ | |
| // Defaults to point at | |
| // "$wgResourceBasePath/resources/assets/poweredby_mediawiki_88x31.png" | |
| // plus srcset for 1.5x, 2x resolution variants. | |
| "src" => null, | |
| "url" => "https://www.mediawiki.org/", | |
| "alt" => "Powered by MediaWiki", | |
| "lang" => "en", | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Login / create account link behavior when it's possible for anonymous users | |
| * to create an account. | |
| * | |
| * - true = use a combined login / create account link | |
| * - false = split login and create account into two separate links | |
| */ | |
| public const UseCombinedLoginLink = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Display user edit counts in various prominent places. | |
| */ | |
| public const Edititis = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Some web hosts attempt to rewrite all responses with a 404 (not found) | |
| * status code, mangling or hiding MediaWiki's output. If you are using such a | |
| * host, you should start looking for a better one. While you're doing that, | |
| * set this to false to convert some of MediaWiki's 404 responses to 200 so | |
| * that the generated error pages can be seen. | |
| * | |
| * In cases where for technical reasons it is more important for MediaWiki to | |
| * send the correct status code than for the body to be transmitted intact, | |
| * this configuration variable is ignored. | |
| */ | |
| public const Send404Code = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The $wgShowRollbackEditCount variable is used to show how many edits can be rolled back. | |
| * | |
| * The numeric value of the variable controls how many edits MediaWiki will look back to | |
| * determine whether a rollback is allowed (by checking that they are all from the same author). | |
| * If the value is false or 0, the edits are not counted. Disabling this will prevent MediaWiki | |
| * from hiding some useless rollback links. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowRollbackEditCount = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Output a <link rel="canonical"> tag on every page indicating the canonical | |
| * server which should be used, i.e. $wgServer or $wgCanonicalServer. Since | |
| * detection of the current server is unreliable, the link is sent | |
| * unconditionally. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableCanonicalServerLink = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of interwiki logos overrides. | |
| * This is used by the sister project sidebar. This list accept a key equal to the | |
| * interwiki ID (as defined in the interwiki links), and accept a Codex icon name | |
| * (https://doc.wikimedia.org/codex/latest/icons/all-icons.html) or a base URL for | |
| * the given interwiki. | |
| * | |
| * Example : | |
| * $wgInterwikiLogoOverride = [ | |
| * 'c' => 'logoWikimediaCommons', | |
| * 'wikit' => 'https://mySpecialWiki.com' | |
| * ]; | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiLogoOverride = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of output format settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region ResourceLoader settings | |
| /** @name ResourceLoader settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Formerly a workaround for a security vulnerability caused by installation | |
| * of Flash as a browser extension. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| * @deprecated since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const MangleFlashPolicy = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'obsolete' => 'Since 1.39; no longer has any effect.', | |
| 'description' => 'Has been emitting warnings since 1.39 (LTS). ' . | |
| 'Can be removed completely in 1.44, assuming 1.43 is an LTS release.' | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Define extra client-side modules to be registered with ResourceLoader. | |
| * | |
| * @note It is recommended to define modules using the `ResourceModule` attribute | |
| * in `extension.json` or `skin.json` when possible (instead of via PHP global variables). | |
| * | |
| * Registration is internally handled by ResourceLoader::register. | |
| * | |
| * ## Available modules | |
| * | |
| * Modules that ship with %MediaWiki core are registered via | |
| * resources/Resources.php. For a full list with documentation, see: | |
| * [ResourceLoader/Core_modules](https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/ResourceLoader/Core_modules). | |
| * | |
| * ## Options | |
| * | |
| * - class `{string}`: | |
| * By default a module is assumed to bundle file resources | |
| * as handled by the MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\FileModule class. Use this option | |
| * to use a different implementation of MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\Module instead. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `\MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\FileModule` | |
| * | |
| * - factory `{string}`: | |
| * Override the instantiation of the MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\Module | |
| * class using a PHP callback. This allows dependency injection to be used. | |
| * This option cannot be combined with the `class` option. | |
| * | |
| * Since: MW 1.30 | |
| * | |
| * - dependencies `{string[]|string}`: | |
| * Modules that must be executed before this module. | |
| * Module name string or list of module name strings. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * - deprecated `{boolean|string}`: | |
| * Whether the module is deprecated and usage is discouraged. | |
| * Set to boolean true, or a string to include in the warning message. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `false` | |
| * | |
| * - group `{string}`: | |
| * Optional request group to override which modules may be downloaded | |
| * together in an HTTP batch request. By default, any two modules may be | |
| * loaded together in the same batch request. Set this option to a | |
| * descriptive string to give the module its own HTTP request. To allow | |
| * other modules to join this new request, give those the same request group. | |
| * | |
| * Use this option with caution. The default behaviour is well-tuned already, | |
| * and setting this often does more harm than good. For more about request | |
| * balancing optimisations, see | |
| * [ResourceLoader/Architecture#Balance](https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/ResourceLoader/Architecture#Balance). | |
| * | |
| * - skipFunction `{string}`: | |
| * Allow this module to be satisfied as dependency without actually loading | |
| * or executing scripts from the server, if the specified JavaScript function | |
| * returns true. | |
| * | |
| * Use this to provide polyfills that are natively available in newer browsers. | |
| * Specify the relative path to a JavaScript file containing a top-level return | |
| * statement. The contents of the file should not contain any wrapping function, | |
| * it will be wrapped by %ResourceLoader in an anonymous function and invoked | |
| * when the module is considered for loading. | |
| * | |
| * ## FileModule options | |
| * | |
| * - localBasePath `{string}`: | |
| * Base file path to prepend to relative file paths specified in other options. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `$IP` | |
| * | |
| * - remoteBasePath `{string}`: | |
| * Base URL path to prepend to relative file paths specified in other options. | |
| * This is used to form URLs for files, such as when referencing images in | |
| * stylesheets, or in debug mode to serve JavaScript files directly. | |
| * | |
| * Default: @ref $wgResourceBasePath (which defaults to @ref $wgScriptPath) | |
| * | |
| * - remoteExtPath `{string}`: | |
| * Shortcut for `remoteBasePath` that is relative to $wgExtensionAssetsPath. | |
| * Use this when defining modules from an extension, so as to avoid hardcoding | |
| * the script path of the %MediaWiki install or the location of the extensions | |
| * directory. | |
| * | |
| * This option is mutually exclusive with `remoteBasePath`. | |
| * | |
| * - remoteSkinPath `{string}`: Like `remoteExtPath`, but relative to $wgStylePath. | |
| * | |
| * - styles `{string[]|string|array<string,array>}`: | |
| * Styles to always include in the module. | |
| * %File path or list of file paths, relative to `localBasePath`. | |
| * The stylesheet can be automatically wrapped in a `@media` query by specifying | |
| * the file path as the key in an object (instead of the value), with the value | |
| * specifying a `media` query. | |
| * | |
| * See @ref wgResourceModules-example-stylesheet "Stylesheet examples" below. | |
| * | |
| * See also @ref $wgResourceModuleSkinStyles. | |
| * | |
| * Extended options: | |
| * | |
| * - skinStyles `{string[]|string}`: Styles to include in specific skin contexts. | |
| * Array keyed is by skin name with file path or list of file paths as value, | |
| * relative to `localBasePath`. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * - noflip `{boolean}`: | |
| * By default, CSSJanus will be used automatically to perform LTR-to-RTL flipping | |
| * when loaded in a right-to-left (RTL) interface language context. | |
| * Use this option to skip CSSJanus LTR-to-RTL flipping for this module, for example | |
| * when registering an external library that already handles RTL styles. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `false` | |
| * | |
| * - packageFiles `{string[]|array[]}` | |
| * Specify script files and (virtual) data files to include in the module. | |
| * Each internal JavaScript file retains its own local module scope and its | |
| * private exports can be accessed separately by other client-side code in the | |
| * same module, via the local `require()` function. | |
| * | |
| * Modules that use package files should export any public API methods using | |
| * `module.exports`. | |
| * | |
| * See examples at | |
| * [ResourceLoader/Package_files](https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/ResourceLoader/Package_files) | |
| * on mediawiki.org. | |
| * | |
| * The `packageFiles` feature cannot be combined with legacy scripts that use | |
| * the `scripts` option, including its extended variants `languageScripts`, | |
| * `skinScripts`, and `debugScripts`. | |
| * | |
| * Since: MW 1.33 | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * - scripts `{string[]|string|array[]}`: | |
| * Scripts to always include in the module. | |
| * %File path or list of file paths, relative to `localBasePath`. | |
| * | |
| * These files are concatenated blindly and executed as a single client-side script. | |
| * Modules using this option are sometimes referred to as "legacy scripts" to | |
| * distinguish them from those that use the `packageFiles` option. | |
| * | |
| * Modules that use legacy scripts usually attach any public APIs they have | |
| * to the `mw` global variable. If a module contains just one file, it is also | |
| * supported to use the newer `module.exports` mechanism, though if the module | |
| * contains more than one legacy script, it is considered unsafe and unsupported | |
| * to use this mechanism (use `packageFiles` instead). See also | |
| * [Coding | |
| * conventions/JavaScript](https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Coding_conventions/JavaScript#Exporting). | |
| * | |
| * Since MW 1.41, an element of `scripts` may be an array in the same format as | |
| * packageFiles, giving a callback to call for content generation. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * Extended options, concatenated in this order: | |
| * | |
| * - languageScripts `{string[]|string|array[]}`: Scripts to include in specific | |
| * language contexts. Array is keyed by language code with file path or list of | |
| * file path. | |
| * - skinScripts `{string[]|string|array[]}`: Scripts to include in specific skin contexts. | |
| * Array keyed is by skin name with file path or list of file paths. | |
| * - debugScripts `{string[]|string|array[]}`: Scripts to include in debug contexts. | |
| * %File path or list of file paths. | |
| * | |
| * - messages `{string[]}` | |
| * Localisation messages to bundle with this module, for client-side use | |
| * via `mw.msg()` and `mw.message()`. List of message keys. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * - templates `{string[]}` | |
| * List of template files to be loaded for client-side usage via `mw.templates`. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `[]` | |
| * | |
| * - es6 `{boolean}`: | |
| * Since: MW 1.36; ignored since MW 1.41. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `true` | |
| * | |
| * - skipStructureTest `{boolean}`: | |
| * Whether to skip ResourcesTest::testRespond(). Since MW 1.42. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `false`. | |
| * | |
| * ## Examples | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Using an alternate subclass** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['ext.myExtension'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => \MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\WikiModule::class, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Deprecated module** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['ext.myExtension'] = [ | |
| * 'deprecated' => 'You should use ext.myExtension2 instead', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Base paths in extension.json** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * "ext.myExtension": { | |
| * "localBasePath": "modules/ext.MyExtension", | |
| * "remoteExtPath": "MyExtension/modules/ext.MyExtension" | |
| * } | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Base paths in core with PHP** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['mediawiki.example'] = [ | |
| * 'localBasePath' => "$IP/resources/src/mediawiki.example", | |
| * 'remoteBasePath' => "$wgResourceBasePath/resources/src/mediawiki.example", | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Define a skip function** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['ext.myExtension.SomeWebAPI'] = [ | |
| * 'skipFunction' => 'skip-SomeWebAPI.js', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Contents of skip function file** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * return typeof SomeWebAPI === 'function' && SomeWebAPI.prototype.duckMethod; | |
| * ``` | |
| * @anchor wgResourceModules-example-stylesheet | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Stylesheets** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['example'] = [ | |
| * 'styles' => [ | |
| * 'foo.css', | |
| * 'bar.css', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * $wgResourceModules['example.media'] = [ | |
| * 'styles' => [ | |
| * 'foo.css' => [ 'media' => 'print' ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * $wgResourceModules['example.mixed'] = [ | |
| * 'styles' => [ | |
| * 'foo.css', | |
| * 'bar.css' => [ 'media' => 'print' ], | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Package files** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * "ext.myExtension": { | |
| * "localBasePath": "modules/ext.MyExtension", | |
| * "remoteExtPath": "MyExtension/modules/ext.MyExtension", | |
| * "packageFiles": [ | |
| * "index.js", | |
| * "utils.js", | |
| * "data.json" | |
| * ] | |
| * } | |
| * } | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Legacy scripts** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['ext.myExtension'] = [ | |
| * 'scripts' => [ | |
| * 'modules/ext.myExtension/utils.js', | |
| * 'modules/ext.myExtension/myExtension.js', | |
| * ], | |
| * 'languageScripts' => [ | |
| * 'bs' => 'modules/ext.myExtension/languages/bs.js', | |
| * 'fi' => 'modules/ext.myExtension/languages/fi.js', | |
| * ], | |
| * 'skinScripts' => [ | |
| * 'default' => 'modules/ext.myExtension/skin-default.js', | |
| * ], | |
| * 'debugScripts' => [ | |
| * 'modules/ext.myExtension/debug.js', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example: Template files** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['ext.myExtension'] = [ | |
| * 'templates' => [ | |
| * 'templates/template.html', | |
| * 'templates/template2.html', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Add extra skin-specific styles to a resource module. | |
| * | |
| * These are automatically added by ResourceLoader to the 'skinStyles' list of | |
| * the existing module. The 'styles' list cannot be modified or disabled. | |
| * | |
| * For example, below a module "bar" is defined and skin Foo provides additional | |
| * styles for it: | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['bar'] = [ | |
| * 'scripts' => 'resources/bar/bar.js', | |
| * 'styles' => 'resources/bar/main.css', | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * $wgResourceModuleSkinStyles['foo'] = [ | |
| * 'bar' => 'skins/Foo/styles/bar.css', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * This is effectively equivalent to: | |
| * | |
| * **Equivalent:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['bar'] = [ | |
| * 'scripts' => 'resources/bar/bar.js', | |
| * 'styles' => 'resources/bar/main.css', | |
| * 'skinStyles' => [ | |
| * 'foo' => skins/Foo/styles/bar.css', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * If the module already defines its own entry in `skinStyles` for a given skin, then | |
| * $wgResourceModuleSkinStyles is ignored. | |
| * | |
| * If a module defines a `skinStyles['default']` the skin may want to extend that instead | |
| * of replacing it. This can be done using the `+` prefix. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['bar'] = [ | |
| * 'scripts' => 'resources/bar/bar.js', | |
| * 'styles' => 'resources/bar/basic.css', | |
| * 'skinStyles' => [ | |
| * 'default' => 'resources/bar/additional.css', | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * // Note the '+' character: | |
| * $wgResourceModuleSkinStyles['foo'] = [ | |
| * '+bar' => 'skins/Foo/styles/bar.css', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * This is effectively equivalent to: | |
| * | |
| * **Equivalent:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModules['bar'] = [ | |
| * 'scripts' => 'resources/bar/bar.js', | |
| * 'styles' => 'resources/bar/basic.css', | |
| * 'skinStyles' => [ | |
| * 'default' => 'resources/bar/additional.css', | |
| * 'foo' => [ | |
| * 'resources/bar/additional.css', | |
| * 'skins/Foo/styles/bar.css', | |
| * ], | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * In other words, as a module author, use the `styles` list for stylesheets that may not be | |
| * disabled by a skin. To provide default styles that may be extended or replaced, | |
| * use `skinStyles['default']`. | |
| * | |
| * As with $wgResourceModules, always set the localBasePath and remoteBasePath | |
| * keys (or one of remoteExtPath/remoteSkinPath). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceModuleSkinStyles['foo'] = [ | |
| * 'bar' => 'bar.css', | |
| * 'quux' => 'quux.css', | |
| * 'remoteSkinPath' => 'Foo/styles', | |
| * 'localBasePath' => __DIR__ . '/styles', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceModuleSkinStyles = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Extensions should register foreign module sources here. 'local' is a | |
| * built-in source that is not in this array, but defined by | |
| * ResourceLoader::__construct() so that it cannot be unset. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgResourceLoaderSources['foo'] = 'http://example.org/w/load.php'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderSources = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The default 'remoteBasePath' value for instances of MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\FileModule. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to $wgScriptPath. | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceBasePath = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ScriptPath' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $scriptPath Value of ScriptPath | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultResourceBasePath( $scriptPath ): string { | |
| return $scriptPath; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Override how long a CDN or browser may cache a ResourceLoader HTTP response. | |
| * | |
| * Maximum time in seconds. Used for the `max-age` and `s-maxage` Cache-Control headers. | |
| * | |
| * Valid keys: | |
| * - versioned | |
| * - unversioned | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\ResourceLoader::__construct | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderMaxage = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The default debug mode (on/off) for of ResourceLoader requests. | |
| * | |
| * This will still be overridden when the debug URL parameter is used. | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderDebug = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * ResourceLoader will not generate URLs whose query string is more than | |
| * this many characters long, and will instead use multiple requests with | |
| * shorter query strings. Using multiple requests may degrade performance, | |
| * but may be needed based on the query string limit supported by your web | |
| * server and/or your user's web browsers. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `2000`. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\StartUpModule::getMaxQueryLength | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderMaxQueryLength = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'integer|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Validate JavaScript code loaded from wiki pages. | |
| * | |
| * If a syntax error is found, the script is replaced with a warning | |
| * logged to the browser console. This ensures errors are found early and | |
| * consistently (independent of the editor's own browser), and prevents | |
| * breaking other modules loaded in the same batch from load.php. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ResourceLoader\Module::validateScriptFile | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderValidateJS = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When enabled, execution of JavaScript modules is profiled client-side. | |
| * | |
| * Instrumentation happens in mw.loader.profiler. | |
| * Use `mw.inspect('time')` from the browser console to display the data. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderEnableJSProfiler = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether ResourceLoader should attempt to persist modules in localStorage on | |
| * browsers that support the Web Storage API. | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderStorageEnabled = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cache version for client-side ResourceLoader module storage. You can trigger | |
| * invalidation of the contents of the module store by incrementing this value. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderStorageVersion = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to include a SourceMap header in ResourceLoader responses | |
| * for JavaScript modules. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const ResourceLoaderEnableSourceMapLinks = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow site-wide CSS (MediaWiki:Common.css and friends) on | |
| * restricted pages like Special:UserLogin or Special:Preferences where | |
| * JavaScript is disabled for security reasons. As it is possible to | |
| * execute JavaScript through CSS, setting this to true opens up a | |
| * potential security hole. Some sites may "skin" their wiki by using | |
| * site-wide CSS, causing restricted pages to look unstyled and different | |
| * from the rest of the site. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowSiteCSSOnRestrictedPages = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use the development version of Vue.js. This should be disabled | |
| * for production installations. For development installations, enabling this | |
| * provides useful additional warnings and checks. | |
| * | |
| * Even when this is disabled, using ResourceLoader's debug mode (?debug=true) | |
| * will cause the development version to be loaded. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const VueDevelopmentMode = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is set, MediaWiki will look for Codex files in this directory | |
| * instead of in resources/lib/codex/ and friends. | |
| * | |
| * To use a local development version of Codex, set this to the full file | |
| * path of the root directory of a local clone of the Codex repository, and | |
| * run `npm run build-all` in the Codex root directory. Rerun this command | |
| * after making any changes. | |
| * | |
| * This should be disabled for production installations. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const CodexDevelopmentDir = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of ResourceLoader settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Page titles and redirects | |
| /** @name Page titles and redirects */ | |
| /** | |
| * Name of the project namespace. If left set to false, $wgSitename will be | |
| * used instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const MetaNamespace = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'Sitename' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $sitename Value of Sitename | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultMetaNamespace( $sitename ): string { | |
| return str_replace( ' ', '_', $sitename ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Name of the project talk namespace. | |
| * | |
| * Normally you can ignore this and it will be something like | |
| * $wgMetaNamespace . "_talk". In some languages, you may want to set this | |
| * manually for grammatical reasons. | |
| */ | |
| public const MetaNamespaceTalk = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Canonical namespace names. | |
| * | |
| * Must not be changed directly in configuration or by extensions, use $wgExtraNamespaces | |
| * instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const CanonicalNamespaceNames = [ | |
| 'default' => NamespaceInfo::CANONICAL_NAMES, | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional namespaces. If the namespaces defined in Language.php and | |
| * Namespace.php are insufficient, you can create new ones here, for example, | |
| * to import Help files in other languages. You can also override the namespace | |
| * names of existing namespaces. Extensions should use the CanonicalNamespaces | |
| * hook or extension.json. | |
| * | |
| * @warning Once you delete a namespace, the pages in that namespace will | |
| * no longer be accessible. If you rename it, then you can access them through | |
| * the new namespace name. | |
| * | |
| * Custom namespaces should start at 100 to avoid conflicting with standard | |
| * namespaces, and should always follow the even/odd main/talk pattern. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExtraNamespaces = [ | |
| * 100 => "Hilfe", | |
| * 101 => "Hilfe_Diskussion", | |
| * 102 => "Aide", | |
| * 103 => "Discussion_Aide" | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * @todo Add a note about maintenance/namespaceDupes.php | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Same as above, but for namespaces with gender distinction. | |
| * | |
| * Note: the default form for the namespace should also be set | |
| * using $wgExtraNamespaces for the same index. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.18 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraGenderNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Define extra namespace aliases. | |
| * | |
| * These are alternate names for the primary localised namespace names, which | |
| * are defined by $wgExtraNamespaces and the language file. If a page is | |
| * requested with such a prefix, the request will be redirected to the primary | |
| * name. | |
| * | |
| * Set this to a map from namespace names to IDs. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgNamespaceAliases = [ | |
| * 'Wikipedian' => NS_USER, | |
| * 'Help' => 100, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Language\Language::getNamespaceAliases for accessing the full list of aliases, | |
| * including those defined by other means. | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespaceAliases = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allowed title characters -- regex character class | |
| * Don't change this unless you know what you're doing | |
| * | |
| * Problematic punctuation: | |
| * - []}|# Are needed for link syntax, never enable these | |
| * - <> Causes problems with HTML escaping, don't use | |
| * - % Enabled by default, minor problems with path to query rewrite rules, see below | |
| * - + Enabled by default, but doesn't work with path to query rewrite rules, | |
| * corrupted by apache | |
| * - ? Enabled by default, but doesn't work with path to PATH_INFO rewrites | |
| * | |
| * All three of these punctuation problems can be avoided by using an alias, | |
| * instead of a rewrite rule of either variety. | |
| * | |
| * The problem with % is that when using a path to query rewrite rule, URLs are | |
| * double-unescaped: once by Apache's path conversion code, and again by PHP. So | |
| * %253F, for example, becomes "?". Our code does not double-escape to compensate | |
| * for this, indeed double escaping would break if the double-escaped title was | |
| * passed in the query string rather than the path. This is a minor security issue | |
| * because articles can be created such that they are hard to view or edit. | |
| * | |
| * In some rare cases you may wish to remove + for compatibility with old links. | |
| * @deprecated since 1.41; use Extension:TitleBlacklist or (soon) | |
| * Extension:AbuseFilter to customize this set. | |
| */ | |
| public const LegalTitleChars = [ | |
| 'default' => ' %!"$&\'()*,\\-.\\/0-9:;=?@A-Z\\\\^_`a-z~\\x80-\\xFF+', | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.41; use Extension:TitleBlacklist to customize', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to false to avoid forcing the first letter of links to capitals. | |
| * | |
| * @warning may break links! This makes links COMPLETELY case-sensitive. Links | |
| * appearing with a capital at the beginning of a sentence will *not* go to the | |
| * same place as links in the middle of a sentence using a lowercase initial. | |
| */ | |
| public const CapitalLinks = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @since 1.16 - This can now be set per-namespace. Some special namespaces (such as Special, | |
| * see NamespaceInfo::ALWAYS_CAPITALIZED_NAMESPACES for the full list) must be true by | |
| * default (and setting them has no effect), due to various things that require them to be | |
| * so. Also, since Talk namespaces need to directly mirror their associated content | |
| * namespaces, the values for those are ignored in favor of the subject namespace's | |
| * setting. Setting for NS_MEDIA is taken automatically from NS_FILE. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgCapitalLinkOverrides[ NS_FILE ] = false; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const CapitalLinkOverrides = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Which namespaces should support subpages? | |
| * See Language.php for a list of namespaces. | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespacesWithSubpages = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| NS_TALK => true, | |
| NS_USER => true, | |
| NS_USER_TALK => true, | |
| NS_PROJECT => true, | |
| NS_PROJECT_TALK => true, | |
| NS_FILE_TALK => true, | |
| NS_MEDIAWIKI => true, | |
| NS_MEDIAWIKI_TALK => true, | |
| NS_TEMPLATE => true, | |
| NS_TEMPLATE_TALK => true, | |
| NS_HELP => true, | |
| NS_HELP_TALK => true, | |
| NS_CATEGORY_TALK => true | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of namespaces which can be deemed to contain valid "content", as far | |
| * as the site statistics are concerned. Useful if additional namespaces also | |
| * contain "content" which should be considered when generating a count of the | |
| * number of articles in the wiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const ContentNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [ NS_MAIN ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Optional array of namespaces which should be excluded from Special:ShortPages. | |
| * | |
| * Only pages inside $wgContentNamespaces but not $wgShortPagesNamespaceExclusions will | |
| * be shown on that page. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37; previously $wgShortPagesNamespaceBlacklist | |
| */ | |
| public const ShortPagesNamespaceExclusions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of namespaces, in addition to the talk namespaces, where signatures | |
| * (~~~~) are likely to be used. This determines whether to display the | |
| * Signature button on the edit toolbar, and may also be used by extensions. | |
| * | |
| * For example, "traditional" style wikis, where content and discussion are | |
| * intermixed, could place NS_MAIN and NS_PROJECT namespaces in this array. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtraSignatureNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of invalid page redirect targets. | |
| * | |
| * Attempting to create a redirect to any of the pages in this array | |
| * will make the redirect fail. | |
| * Userlogout is hard-coded, so it does not need to be listed here. | |
| * (T12569) Disallow Mypage and Mytalk as well. | |
| * | |
| * As of now, this only checks special pages. Redirects to pages in | |
| * other namespaces cannot be invalidated by this variable. | |
| */ | |
| public const InvalidRedirectTargets = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'Filepath', 'Mypage', 'Mytalk', 'Redirect', 'Mylog' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable redirects to special pages and interwiki redirects, which use a 302 | |
| * and have no "redirected from" link. | |
| * | |
| * @note This is only for articles with #REDIRECT in them. URL's containing a | |
| * local interwiki prefix (or a non-canonical special page name) are still hard | |
| * redirected regardless of this setting. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableHardRedirects = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Fix double redirects after a page move. | |
| * | |
| * Tends to conflict with page move vandalism, use only on a private wiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const FixDoubleRedirects = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of title and interwiki settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Interwiki links and sites | |
| /** @name Interwiki links and sites */ | |
| /** | |
| * Array for local interwiki values, for each of the interwiki prefixes that point to | |
| * the current wiki. | |
| * | |
| * Note, recent changes feeds use only the first entry in this array. See $wgRCFeeds. | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalInterwikis = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expiry time for cache of interwiki table | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 10800, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Interwiki cache as an associative array. | |
| * | |
| * When set, the InterwikiLookup service will not use the built-in `interwiki` database table, | |
| * but instead use this static array as its source. | |
| * | |
| * This cache data structure can be generated by the `dumpInterwiki.php` maintenance | |
| * script (which lives in the WikimediaMaintenance repository) and has key | |
| * formats such as the following: | |
| * | |
| * - dbname:key - a simple key (e.g. enwiki:meta) | |
| * - _sitename:key - site-scope key (e.g. wiktionary:meta) | |
| * - __global:key - global-scope key (e.g. __global:meta) | |
| * - __sites:dbname - site mapping (e.g. __sites:enwiki) | |
| * | |
| * Sites mapping just specifies site name, other keys provide "local url" | |
| * data layout. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Interwiki\ClassicInterwikiLookup | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiCache = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'replace', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Specify number of domains to check for messages. | |
| * | |
| * - 1: Just wiki(db)-level | |
| * - 2: wiki and global levels | |
| * - 3: site levels | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiScopes = [ | |
| 'default' => 3, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Fallback site, if unable to resolve from cache | |
| */ | |
| public const InterwikiFallbackSite = [ | |
| 'default' => 'wiki', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If local interwikis are set up which allow redirects, | |
| * set this regexp to restrict URLs which will be displayed | |
| * as 'redirected from' links. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * It might look something like this: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRedirectSources = '!^https?://[a-z-]+\.wikipedia\.org/!'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Leave at false to avoid displaying any incoming redirect markers. | |
| * This does not affect intra-wiki redirects, which don't change | |
| * the URL. | |
| */ | |
| public const RedirectSources = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Register handlers for specific types of sites. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const SiteTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'mediawiki' => MediaWikiSite::class, ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- Interwiki links and sites | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Parser settings | |
| /** @name Parser settings | |
| * These settings configure the transformation from wikitext to HTML. | |
| */ | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum indent level of toc. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxTocLevel = [ | |
| 'default' => 999, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A complexity limit on template expansion: the maximum number of nodes visited | |
| * by PPFrame::expand() | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxPPNodeCount = [ | |
| 'default' => 1_000_000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum recursion depth for templates within templates. | |
| * | |
| * The current parser adds two levels to the PHP call stack for each template, | |
| * and xdebug limits the call stack to 256 by default. So this should hopefully | |
| * stop the parser before it hits the xdebug limit. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxTemplateDepth = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::MaxTemplateDepth | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxPPExpandDepth = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * URL schemes that should be recognized as valid by UrlUtils::parse(). | |
| * | |
| * WARNING: Do not add 'file:' to this or internal file links will be broken. | |
| * Instead, if you want to support file links, add 'file://'. The same applies | |
| * to any other protocols with the same name as a namespace. See task T46011 for | |
| * more information. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Utils\UrlUtils::parse() | |
| */ | |
| public const UrlProtocols = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'bitcoin:', 'ftp://', 'ftps://', 'geo:', 'git://', 'gopher://', 'http://', | |
| 'https://', 'irc://', 'ircs://', 'magnet:', 'mailto:', 'matrix:', 'mms://', | |
| 'news:', 'nntp://', 'redis://', 'sftp://', 'sip:', 'sips:', 'sms:', | |
| 'ssh://', 'svn://', 'tel:', 'telnet://', 'urn:', 'wikipedia://', 'worldwind://', | |
| 'xmpp:', '//', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, removes (by substituting) templates in signatures. | |
| */ | |
| public const CleanSignatures = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow inline image pointing to other websites | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowExternalImages = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If the above is false, you can specify an exception here. Image URLs | |
| * that start with this string are then rendered, while all others are not. | |
| * | |
| * You can use this to set up a trusted, simple repository of images. | |
| * You may also specify an array of strings to allow multiple sites | |
| * | |
| * **Examples:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAllowExternalImagesFrom = 'http://127.0.0.1/'; | |
| * $wgAllowExternalImagesFrom = [ 'http://127.0.0.1/', 'http://example.com' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowExternalImagesFrom = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If $wgAllowExternalImages is false, you can allow an on-wiki | |
| * allow list of regular expression fragments to match the image URL | |
| * against. If the image matches one of the regular expression fragments, | |
| * the image will be displayed. | |
| * | |
| * Set this to true to enable the on-wiki allow list (MediaWiki:External image whitelist) | |
| * Or false to disable it | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.14 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableImageWhitelist = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for HTML postprocessing tool. Set this to a configuration | |
| * array to enable an external tool. By default, we now use the RemexHtml | |
| * library; historically, other postprocessors were used. | |
| * | |
| * Setting this to null will use default settings. | |
| * | |
| * Keys include: | |
| * - treeMutationTrace: a boolean to turn on Remex tracing | |
| * - serializerTrace: a boolean to turn on Remex tracing | |
| * - mungerTrace: a boolean to turn on Remex tracing | |
| * - pwrap: whether <p> wrapping should be done (default true) | |
| * | |
| * See includes/tidy/RemexDriver.php for detail on configuration. | |
| * | |
| * Overriding the default configuration is strongly discouraged in | |
| * production. | |
| */ | |
| public const TidyConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default Parsoid configuration. | |
| * | |
| * Overriding the default configuration is strongly discouraged in | |
| * production. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const ParsoidSettings = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'useSelser' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set, Parsoid's HTML output for parser functions will be different | |
| * from Parsoid HTML spec 2.x.x and lets us experiment with a better | |
| * output that might be rolled out in a future 3.x Parsoid HTML version. | |
| * Parsoid will start generating this output for wikifunctions parser function | |
| * whenever that code is rolled out to production and will let us experiment | |
| * with this new format and tweak it now. This also lets Parsoid developers | |
| * experiment with it locally. | |
| * | |
| * This is an experimental flag and might be removed without notice. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| */ | |
| public const ParsoidExperimentalParserFunctionOutput = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable shipping the styles for the legacy media HTML structure. | |
| * This is to give time for templates and extensions that mimic the | |
| * legacy output to be migrated away. | |
| * | |
| * @internal Temporary feature flag for T318433. | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseLegacyMediaStyles = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow raw, unchecked HTML in "<html>...</html>" sections. | |
| * | |
| * THIS IS VERY DANGEROUS on a publicly editable site, so USE $wgGroupPermissions | |
| * TO RESTRICT EDITING to only those that you trust | |
| */ | |
| public const RawHtml = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set a default target for external links, e.g. _blank to pop up a new window. | |
| * | |
| * This will also set the "noreferrer" and "noopener" link rel to prevent the | |
| * attack described at https://mathiasbynens.github.io/rel-noopener/ . | |
| * Some older browsers may not support these link attributes, hence | |
| * setting $wgExternalLinkTarget to _blank may represent a security risk | |
| * to some of your users. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalLinkTarget = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, external URL links in wiki text will be given the | |
| * rel="nofollow" attribute as a hint to search engines that | |
| * they should not be followed for ranking purposes as they | |
| * are user-supplied and thus subject to spamming. | |
| */ | |
| public const NoFollowLinks = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Namespaces in which $wgNoFollowLinks doesn't apply. | |
| * | |
| * See Language.php for a list of namespaces. | |
| */ | |
| public const NoFollowNsExceptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is set to an array of domains, external links to these domain names | |
| * (or any subdomains) will not be set to rel="nofollow" regardless of the | |
| * value of $wgNoFollowLinks. For instance: | |
| * | |
| * $wgNoFollowDomainExceptions = [ 'en.wikipedia.org', 'wiktionary.org', 'mediawiki.org' ]; | |
| * | |
| * This would add rel="nofollow" to links to de.wikipedia.org, but not | |
| * en.wikipedia.org, wiktionary.org, en.wiktionary.org, us.en.wikipedia.org, | |
| * etc. | |
| * | |
| * Defaults to mediawiki.org for the links included in the software by default. | |
| */ | |
| public const NoFollowDomainExceptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'mediawiki.org', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * By default MediaWiki does not register links pointing to same server in | |
| * externallinks dataset, use this value to override: | |
| */ | |
| public const RegisterInternalExternals = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow DISPLAYTITLE to change title display | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowDisplayTitle = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * For consistency, restrict DISPLAYTITLE to text that normalizes to the same | |
| * canonical DB key. Also disallow some inline CSS rules like display: none; | |
| * which can cause the text to be hidden or unselectable. | |
| */ | |
| public const RestrictDisplayTitle = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of calls per parse to expensive parser functions such as | |
| * PAGESINCATEGORY. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExpensiveParserFunctionLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Preprocessor caching threshold | |
| * Setting it to 'false' will disable the preprocessor cache. | |
| */ | |
| public const PreprocessorCacheThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => 1000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable interwiki transcluding. Only when iw_trans=1 in the interwiki table. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableScaryTranscluding = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expiry time for transcluded templates cached in object cache. | |
| * | |
| * Only used $wgEnableInterwikiTranscluding is set to true. | |
| */ | |
| public const TranscludeCacheExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 3600, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable the magic links feature of automatically turning ISBN xxx, | |
| * PMID xxx, RFC xxx into links | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.28 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableMagicLinks = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'ISBN' => false, | |
| 'PMID' => false, | |
| 'RFC' => false, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true to allow the {{USERLANGUAGE}} magic word to return the | |
| * actual user language. If it is false, {{USERLANGUAGE}} will return the | |
| * page language. Setting this to true is discouraged since the page | |
| * language should typically be used in the content area. Accessing the user | |
| * language using this feature reduces the efficiency of the parser cache. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const ParserEnableUserLanguage = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of parser settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Statistics and content analysis | |
| /** @name Statistics and content analysis */ | |
| /** | |
| * Method used to determine if a page in a content namespace should be counted | |
| * as a valid article. | |
| * | |
| * Redirect pages will never be counted as valid articles. | |
| * | |
| * This variable can have the following values: | |
| * - 'any': all pages as considered as valid articles | |
| * - 'link': the page must contain a [[wiki link]] to be considered valid | |
| * | |
| * See also See https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Article_count | |
| * | |
| * Retroactively changing this variable will not affect the existing count, | |
| * to update it, you will need to run the maintenance/updateArticleCount.php | |
| * script. | |
| */ | |
| public const ArticleCountMethod = [ | |
| 'default' => 'link', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * How many days user must be idle before they are considered inactive. Will affect | |
| * the number shown on Special:Statistics, Special:ActiveUsers, and the | |
| * {{NUMBEROFACTIVEUSERS}} magic word in wikitext. | |
| * | |
| * You might want to leave this as the default value, to provide comparable | |
| * numbers between different wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const ActiveUserDays = [ | |
| 'default' => 30, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The following variables define 3 user experience levels: | |
| * | |
| * - newcomer: has not yet reached the 'learner' level | |
| * | |
| * - learner: has at least $wgLearnerEdits and has been | |
| * a member for $wgLearnerMemberSince days | |
| * but has not yet reached the 'experienced' level. | |
| * | |
| * - experienced: has at least $wgExperiencedUserEdits edits and | |
| * has been a member for $wgExperiencedUserMemberSince days. | |
| */ | |
| public const LearnerEdits = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of days the user must exist before becoming a learner. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::LearnerEdits | |
| */ | |
| public const LearnerMemberSince = [ | |
| 'default' => 4, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of edits the user must have before becoming "experienced". | |
| * | |
| * @see self::LearnerEdits | |
| */ | |
| public const ExperiencedUserEdits = [ | |
| 'default' => 500, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of days the user must exist before becoming "experienced". | |
| * | |
| * @see self::LearnerEdits | |
| */ | |
| public const ExperiencedUserMemberSince = [ | |
| 'default' => 30, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of revisions of a page that will be checked against every new edit | |
| * made to determine whether the edit was a manual revert. | |
| * | |
| * Computational time required increases roughly linearly with this configuration | |
| * variable. | |
| * | |
| * Larger values will let you detect very deep reverts, but at the same time can give | |
| * unexpected results (such as marking large amounts of edits as reverts) and may slow | |
| * down the wiki slightly when saving new edits. | |
| * | |
| * Setting this to 0 will disable the manual revert detection feature entirely. | |
| * | |
| * See this document for a discussion on this topic: | |
| * https://meta.wikimedia.org/wiki/Research:Revert | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const ManualRevertSearchRadius = [ | |
| 'default' => 15, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum depth (revision count) of reverts that will have their reverted edits marked | |
| * with the mw-reverted change tag. Reverts deeper than that will not have any edits | |
| * marked as reverted at all. | |
| * | |
| * Large values can lead to lots of revisions being marked as "reverted", which may appear | |
| * confusing to users. | |
| * | |
| * Setting this to 0 will disable the reverted tag entirely. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const RevertedTagMaxDepth = [ | |
| 'default' => 15, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of statistics and content analysis | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region User accounts, authentication | |
| /** @name User accounts, authentication */ | |
| /** | |
| * Central ID lookup providers | |
| * Key is the provider ID, value is a specification for ObjectFactory | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const CentralIdLookupProviders = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'local' => [ | |
| 'class' => LocalIdLookup::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory', | |
| 'HideUserUtils', | |
| ] | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Central ID lookup provider to use by default | |
| */ | |
| public const CentralIdLookupProvider = [ | |
| 'default' => 'local', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * User registration timestamp provider classes | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const UserRegistrationProviders = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| LocalUserRegistrationProvider::TYPE => [ | |
| 'class' => LocalUserRegistrationProvider::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'ConnectionProvider', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Password policy for the wiki. | |
| * | |
| * Structured as | |
| * ``` | |
| * [ | |
| * 'policies' => [ <group> => [ <policy> => <settings>, ... ], ... ], | |
| * 'checks' => [ <policy> => <callback>, ... ], | |
| * ] | |
| * ``` | |
| * where <group> is a user group, <policy> is a password policy name | |
| * (arbitrary string) defined in the 'checks' part, <callback> is the | |
| * PHP callable implementing the policy check, <settings> is an array | |
| * of options with the following keys: | |
| * - value: (number, boolean or null) the value to pass to the callback | |
| * - forceChange: (boolean, default false) if the password is invalid, do | |
| * not let the user log in without changing the password | |
| * - suggestChangeOnLogin: (boolean, default false) if true and the password is | |
| * invalid, suggest a password change if logging in. If all the failing policies | |
| * that apply to the user have this set to false, the password change | |
| * screen will not be shown. 'forceChange' takes precedence over | |
| * 'suggestChangeOnLogin' if they are both present. | |
| * As a shorthand for [ 'value' => <value> ], simply <value> can be written. | |
| * When multiple password policies are defined for a user, the settings | |
| * arrays are merged, and for fields which are set in both arrays, the | |
| * larger value (as understood by PHP's 'max' method) is taken. | |
| * | |
| * A user's effective policy is the superset of all policy statements | |
| * from the policies for the groups where the user is a member. If more | |
| * than one group policy include the same policy statement, the value is | |
| * the max() of the values. Note true > false. The 'default' policy group | |
| * is required, and serves as the minimum policy for all users. | |
| * | |
| * Callbacks receive three arguments: the policy value, the User object | |
| * and the password; and must return a StatusValue. A non-good status | |
| * means the password will not be accepted for new accounts, and existing | |
| * accounts will be prompted for password change or barred from logging in | |
| * (depending on whether the status is a fatal or merely error/warning). | |
| * | |
| * The checks supported by core are: | |
| * - MinimalPasswordLength - Minimum length a user can set. | |
| * - MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin - Passwords shorter than this will | |
| * not be allowed to login, or offered a chance to reset their password | |
| * as part of the login workflow, regardless if it is correct. | |
| * - MaximalPasswordLength - maximum length password a user is allowed | |
| * to attempt. Prevents DoS attacks with pbkdf2. | |
| * - PasswordCannotBeSubstringInUsername - Password cannot be a substring | |
| * (contained within) the username. | |
| * - PasswordCannotMatchDefaults - Username/password combination cannot | |
| * match a list of default passwords used by MediaWiki in the past. | |
| * - PasswordNotInCommonList - Password not in best practices list of | |
| * 100,000 commonly used passwords. Due to the size of the list this | |
| * is a probabilistic test. | |
| * | |
| * If you add custom checks, for Special:PasswordPolicies to display them correctly, | |
| * every check should have a corresponding passwordpolicies-policy-<check> message, | |
| * and every settings field other than 'value' should have a corresponding | |
| * passwordpolicies-policyflag-<flag> message (<check> and <flag> are in lowercase). | |
| * The check message receives the policy value as a parameter, the flag message | |
| * receives the flag value (or values if it's an array). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Password\PasswordPolicyChecks | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\User\User::checkPasswordValidity() | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordPolicy = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'policies' => [ | |
| 'bureaucrat' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => 10, | |
| 'MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' => 1, | |
| ], | |
| 'sysop' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => 10, | |
| 'MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' => 1, | |
| ], | |
| 'interface-admin' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => 10, | |
| 'MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' => 1, | |
| ], | |
| 'bot' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => 10, | |
| 'MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' => 1, | |
| ], | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => [ 'value' => 8, 'suggestChangeOnLogin' => true ], | |
| 'PasswordCannotBeSubstringInUsername' => [ | |
| 'value' => true, | |
| 'suggestChangeOnLogin' => true | |
| ], | |
| 'PasswordCannotMatchDefaults' => [ 'value' => true, 'suggestChangeOnLogin' => true ], | |
| 'MaximalPasswordLength' => [ 'value' => 4096, 'suggestChangeOnLogin' => true ], | |
| 'PasswordNotInCommonList' => [ 'value' => true, 'suggestChangeOnLogin' => true ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'checks' => [ | |
| 'MinimalPasswordLength' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkMinimalPasswordLength' ], | |
| 'MinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkMinimumPasswordLengthToLogin' ], | |
| 'PasswordCannotBeSubstringInUsername' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkPasswordCannotBeSubstringInUsername' ], | |
| 'PasswordCannotMatchDefaults' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkPasswordCannotMatchDefaults' ], | |
| 'MaximalPasswordLength' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkMaximalPasswordLength' ], | |
| 'PasswordNotInCommonList' => [ PasswordPolicyChecks::class, 'checkPasswordNotInCommonList' ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_replace_recursive', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configure AuthManager | |
| * | |
| * All providers are constructed using ObjectFactory, see that for the general | |
| * structure. The array may also contain a key "sort" used to order providers: | |
| * providers are stably sorted by this value, which should be an integer | |
| * (default is 0). | |
| * | |
| * Elements are: | |
| * - preauth: Array (keys ignored) of specifications for PreAuthenticationProviders | |
| * - primaryauth: Array (keys ignored) of specifications for PrimaryAuthenticationProviders | |
| * - secondaryauth: Array (keys ignored) of specifications for SecondaryAuthenticationProviders | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| * @note If this is null or empty, the value from $wgAuthManagerAutoConfig is | |
| * used instead. Local customization should generally set this variable from | |
| * scratch to the desired configuration. Extensions that want to | |
| * auto-configure themselves should use $wgAuthManagerAutoConfig instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const AuthManagerConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::AuthManagerConfig | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const AuthManagerAutoConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'preauth' => [ | |
| ThrottlePreAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => ThrottlePreAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'sort' => 0, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'primaryauth' => [ | |
| // TemporaryPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider should come before | |
| // any other PasswordAuthenticationRequest-based | |
| // PrimaryAuthenticationProvider (or at least any that might return | |
| // FAIL rather than ABSTAIN for a wrong password), or password reset | |
| // won't work right. Do not remove this (or change the key) or | |
| // auto-configuration of other such providers in extensions will | |
| // probably auto-insert themselves in the wrong place. | |
| TemporaryPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => TemporaryPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory', | |
| 'UserOptionsLookup', | |
| ], | |
| 'args' => [ [ | |
| // Fall through to LocalPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider | |
| 'authoritative' => false, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'sort' => 0, | |
| ], | |
| LocalPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => LocalPasswordPrimaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory', | |
| ], | |
| 'args' => [ [ | |
| // Last one should be authoritative, or else the user will get | |
| // a less-than-helpful error message (something like "supplied | |
| // authentication info not supported" rather than "wrong | |
| // password") if it too fails. | |
| 'authoritative' => true, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'sort' => 100, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'secondaryauth' => [ | |
| CheckBlocksSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => CheckBlocksSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'sort' => 0, | |
| ], | |
| ResetPasswordSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => ResetPasswordSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'sort' => 100, | |
| ], | |
| // Linking during login is experimental, enable at your own risk - T134952 | |
| // MediaWiki\Auth\ConfirmLinkSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| // 'class' => MediaWiki\Auth\ConfirmLinkSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| // 'sort' => 100, | |
| // ], | |
| EmailNotificationSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => EmailNotificationSecondaryAuthenticationProvider::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory', | |
| ], | |
| 'sort' => 200, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configures RememberMe authentication request added by AuthManager. It can show a "remember | |
| * me" checkbox that, when checked, will cause it to take more time for the authenticated | |
| * session to expire. It can also be configured to always or to never extend the authentication | |
| * session. | |
| * | |
| * Valid values are listed in RememberMeAuthenticationRequest::ALLOWED_FLAGS. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const RememberMe = [ | |
| 'default' => 'choose', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Time frame for re-authentication. | |
| * | |
| * With only password-based authentication, you'd just ask the user to re-enter | |
| * their password to verify certain operations like changing the password or | |
| * changing the account's email address. But under AuthManager, the user might | |
| * not have a password (you might even have to redirect the browser to a | |
| * third-party service or something complex like that), you might want to have | |
| * both factors of a two-factor authentication, and so on. So, the options are: | |
| * - Incorporate the whole multi-step authentication flow within everything | |
| * that needs to do this. | |
| * - Consider it good if they used Special:UserLogin during this session within | |
| * the last X seconds. | |
| * - Come up with a third option. | |
| * | |
| * MediaWiki currently takes the second option. This setting configures the | |
| * "X seconds". | |
| * | |
| * This allows for configuring different time frames for different | |
| * "operations". The operations used in MediaWiki core include: | |
| * - LinkAccounts | |
| * - UnlinkAccount | |
| * - ChangeCredentials | |
| * - RemoveCredentials | |
| * - ChangeEmail | |
| * | |
| * Additional operations may be used by extensions, either explicitly by | |
| * calling AuthManager::securitySensitiveOperationStatus(), | |
| * ApiAuthManagerHelper::securitySensitiveOperation() or | |
| * SpecialPage::checkLoginSecurityLevel(), or implicitly by overriding | |
| * SpecialPage::getLoginSecurityLevel() or by subclassing | |
| * AuthManagerSpecialPage. | |
| * | |
| * The key 'default' is used if a requested operation isn't defined in the array. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const ReauthenticateTime = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'default' => 3600, ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'integer', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow security-sensitive operations when re-authentication is not possible. | |
| * | |
| * If AuthManager::canAuthenticateNow() is false (e.g. the current | |
| * SessionProvider is not able to change users, such as when OAuth is in use), | |
| * AuthManager::securitySensitiveOperationStatus() cannot sensibly return | |
| * SEC_REAUTH. Setting an operation true here will have it return SEC_OK in | |
| * that case, while setting it false will have it return SEC_FAIL. | |
| * | |
| * The key 'default' is used if a requested operation isn't defined in the array. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| * @see self::ReauthenticateTime | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowSecuritySensitiveOperationIfCannotReauthenticate = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'default' => true, ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'boolean', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of AuthenticationRequest class names which are not changeable through | |
| * Special:ChangeCredentials and the changeauthenticationdata API. | |
| * | |
| * This is only enforced on the client level; AuthManager itself (e.g. | |
| * AuthManager::allowsAuthenticationDataChange calls) is not affected. | |
| * Class names are checked for exact match (not for subclasses). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const ChangeCredentialsBlacklist = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| TemporaryPasswordAuthenticationRequest::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of AuthenticationRequest class names which are not removable through | |
| * Special:RemoveCredentials and the removeauthenticationdata API. | |
| * | |
| * This is only enforced on the client level; AuthManager itself (e.g. | |
| * AuthManager::allowsAuthenticationDataChange calls) is not affected. | |
| * Class names are checked for exact match (not for subclasses). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const RemoveCredentialsBlacklist = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| PasswordAuthenticationRequest::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Specifies if users should be sent to a password-reset form on login, if their | |
| * password doesn't meet the requirements of User::isValidPassword(). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const InvalidPasswordReset = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default password type to use when hashing user passwords. | |
| * | |
| * Must be set to a type defined in $wgPasswordConfig, or a type that | |
| * is registered by default in PasswordFactory.php. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordDefault = [ | |
| 'default' => 'pbkdf2', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for built-in password types. | |
| * | |
| * Maps the password type to an array of options: | |
| * | |
| * - class: The Password class to use. | |
| * - factory (since 1.40): A function that creates and returns a suitable Password object. | |
| * This option is intended only for internal use; the function signature is unstable and | |
| * subject to change in future versions. | |
| * | |
| * All other options are class-dependent. | |
| * | |
| * An advanced example: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgPasswordConfig['bcrypt-peppered'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => EncryptedPassword::class, | |
| * 'underlying' => 'bcrypt', | |
| * 'secrets' => [ | |
| * hash( 'sha256', 'secret', true ), | |
| * ], | |
| * 'cipher' => 'aes-256-cbc', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.24 | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'A' => [ | |
| 'class' => MWOldPassword::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'B' => [ | |
| 'class' => MWSaltedPassword::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'pbkdf2-legacyA' => [ | |
| 'class' => LayeredParameterizedPassword::class, | |
| 'types' => [ | |
| 'A', | |
| 'pbkdf2', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'pbkdf2-legacyB' => [ | |
| 'class' => LayeredParameterizedPassword::class, | |
| 'types' => [ | |
| 'B', | |
| 'pbkdf2', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'bcrypt' => [ | |
| 'class' => BcryptPassword::class, | |
| 'cost' => 9, | |
| ], | |
| 'pbkdf2' => [ | |
| 'class' => Pbkdf2PasswordUsingOpenSSL::class, | |
| 'algo' => 'sha512', | |
| 'cost' => '30000', | |
| 'length' => '64', | |
| ], | |
| 'argon2' => [ | |
| 'class' => Argon2Password::class, | |
| // Algorithm used: | |
| // * 'argon2i' is optimized against side-channel attacks | |
| // * 'argon2id' is optimized against both side-channel and GPU cracking | |
| // * 'auto' to use the best available algorithm. If you're using more than one server, be | |
| // careful when you're mixing PHP versions because newer PHP might generate hashes that | |
| // older versions would not understand. | |
| 'algo' => 'auto', | |
| // The parameters below are the same as options accepted by password_hash(). | |
| // Set them to override that function's defaults. | |
| // | |
| // 'memory_cost' => PASSWORD_ARGON2_DEFAULT_MEMORY_COST, | |
| // 'time_cost' => PASSWORD_ARGON2_DEFAULT_TIME_COST, | |
| // 'threads' => PASSWORD_ARGON2_DEFAULT_THREADS, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow password resets ("enter some identifying data, and we'll send an email | |
| * with a temporary password you can use to get back into the account") identified by | |
| * various bits of data. Setting all of these to false (or the whole variable to false) | |
| * has the effect of disabling password resets entirely | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordResetRoutes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'username' => true, | |
| 'email' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of Unicode characters in signature | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxSigChars = [ | |
| 'default' => 255, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Behavior of signature validation. Allowed values are: | |
| * - 'warning' - invalid signatures cause a warning to be displayed on the preferences page, | |
| * but they are still used when signing comments; new invalid signatures can still be saved as | |
| * normal | |
| * - 'new' - existing invalid signatures behave as above; new invalid signatures can't be | |
| * saved | |
| * - 'disallow' - existing invalid signatures are no longer used when signing comments; new | |
| * invalid signatures can't be saved | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const SignatureValidation = [ | |
| 'default' => 'warning', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of lint error codes which don't cause signature validation to fail. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Help:Lint_errors | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const SignatureAllowedLintErrors = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'obsolete-tag', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of bytes in username. You want to run the maintenance | |
| * script ./maintenance/checkUsernames.php once you have changed this value. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxNameChars = [ | |
| 'default' => 255, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of usernames which may not be registered or logged in from | |
| * Maintenance scripts can still use these | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\User\User::MAINTENANCE_SCRIPT_USER | |
| */ | |
| public const ReservedUsernames = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'MediaWiki default', // Default 'Main Page' and MediaWiki: message pages | |
| 'Conversion script', // Used for the old Wikipedia software upgrade | |
| 'Maintenance script', // Maintenance scripts which perform editing, image import script | |
| 'Template namespace initialisation script', // Used in 1.2->1.3 upgrade | |
| 'ScriptImporter', // Default user name used by maintenance/importSiteScripts.php | |
| 'Delete page script', // Default user name used by maintenance/deleteBatch.php | |
| 'Move page script', // Default user name used by maintenance/deleteBatch.php | |
| 'Command line script', // Default user name used by maintenance/undelete.php | |
| 'Unknown user', // Used in WikiImporter & RevisionStore for revisions with no author and in User for invalid user id | |
| 'msg:double-redirect-fixer', // Automatic double redirect fix | |
| 'msg:usermessage-editor', // Default user for leaving user messages | |
| 'msg:proxyblocker', // For $wgProxyList and Special:Blockme (removed in 1.22) | |
| 'msg:sorbs', // For $wgEnableDnsBlacklist etc. | |
| 'msg:spambot_username', // Used by cleanupSpam.php | |
| 'msg:autochange-username', // Used by anon category RC entries (removed in 1.44) | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Settings added to this array will override the default globals for the user | |
| * preferences used by anonymous visitors and newly created accounts. | |
| * | |
| * For instance, to disable editing on double clicks: | |
| * $wgDefaultUserOptions ['editondblclick'] = 0; | |
| * | |
| * To save storage space, no user_properties row will be stored for users with the | |
| * default setting for a given option, even if the user manually selects that option. | |
| * This means that a change to the defaults will change the setting for all users who | |
| * have been using the default setting; there is no way for users to opt out of this. | |
| * $wgConditionalUserOptions can be used to change the default value for future users | |
| * only. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::ConditionalUserOptions | |
| */ | |
| public const DefaultUserOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => | |
| // This array should be sorted by key | |
| [ | |
| 'ccmeonemails' => 0, | |
| 'date' => 'default', | |
| 'diffonly' => 0, | |
| 'diff-type' => 'table', | |
| 'disablemail' => 0, | |
| 'editfont' => 'monospace', | |
| 'editondblclick' => 0, | |
| 'editrecovery' => 0, | |
| 'editsectiononrightclick' => 0, | |
| 'email-allow-new-users' => 1, | |
| 'enotifminoredits' => 0, | |
| 'enotifrevealaddr' => 0, | |
| 'enotifusertalkpages' => 1, | |
| 'enotifwatchlistpages' => 1, | |
| 'extendwatchlist' => 1, | |
| 'fancysig' => 0, | |
| 'forceeditsummary' => 0, | |
| 'forcesafemode' => 0, | |
| 'gender' => 'unknown', | |
| 'hidecategorization' => 1, | |
| 'hideminor' => 0, | |
| 'hidepatrolled' => 0, | |
| 'imagesize' => 2, | |
| 'minordefault' => 0, | |
| 'newpageshidepatrolled' => 0, | |
| 'nickname' => '', | |
| 'norollbackdiff' => 0, | |
| 'prefershttps' => 1, | |
| 'previewonfirst' => 0, | |
| 'previewontop' => 1, | |
| 'pst-cssjs' => 1, | |
| 'rcdays' => 7, | |
| 'rcenhancedfilters-disable' => 0, | |
| 'rclimit' => 50, | |
| 'requireemail' => 0, | |
| 'search-match-redirect' => true, | |
| 'search-special-page' => 'Search', | |
| 'search-thumbnail-extra-namespaces' => true, | |
| 'searchlimit' => 20, | |
| 'showhiddencats' => 0, | |
| 'shownumberswatching' => 1, | |
| 'showrollbackconfirmation' => 0, | |
| 'skin' => false, | |
| 'skin-responsive' => 1, | |
| 'thumbsize' => 5, | |
| 'underline' => 2, | |
| 'useeditwarning' => 1, | |
| 'uselivepreview' => 0, | |
| 'usenewrc' => 1, | |
| 'watchcreations' => 1, | |
| 'watchcreations-expiry' => 'infinite', | |
| 'watchdefault' => 1, | |
| 'watchdefault-expiry' => 'infinite', | |
| 'watchdeletion' => 0, | |
| 'watchlistdays' => 7, | |
| 'watchlisthideanons' => 0, | |
| 'watchlisthidebots' => 0, | |
| 'watchlisthidecategorization' => 1, | |
| 'watchlisthideliu' => 0, | |
| 'watchlisthideminor' => 0, | |
| 'watchlisthideown' => 0, | |
| 'watchlisthidepatrolled' => 0, | |
| 'watchlistreloadautomatically' => 0, | |
| 'watchlistunwatchlinks' => 0, | |
| 'watchmoves' => 0, | |
| 'watchrollback' => 0, | |
| 'watchuploads' => 1, | |
| 'watchrollback-expiry' => 'infinite', | |
| 'watchstar-expiry' => 'infinite', | |
| 'wlenhancedfilters-disable' => 0, | |
| 'wllimit' => 250, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Conditional defaults for user options | |
| * | |
| * Map of user options to conditional defaults descriptors, which is an array | |
| * of conditional cases [ VALUE, CONDITION1, CONDITION2, ... ], where VALUE is the default value for | |
| * all users that meet ALL conditions, and each CONDITION is either a: | |
| * (a) a CUDCOND_* constant (when condition does not take any arguments), or | |
| * (b) an array [ CUDCOND_*, argument1, argument1, ... ] (when chosen condition takes at | |
| * least one argument). | |
| * | |
| * When `null` is used as the VALUE, it is interpreted as "no conditional default for this | |
| * condition". In other words, `null` and $wgDefaultUserOptions['user-option'] can be used | |
| * interchangeably as the VALUE. | |
| * | |
| * All conditions are evaluated in order. When no condition matches. | |
| * $wgDefaultUserOptions is used instead. | |
| * | |
| * Example of valid configuration: | |
| * $wgConditionalUserOptions['user-option'] = [ | |
| * [ 'registered in 2024', [ CUDCOND_AFTER, '20240101000000' ] ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * List of valid conditions: | |
| * * CUDCOND_AFTER: user registered after given timestamp (args: string $timestamp) | |
| * * CUDCOND_ANON: allows specifying a default for anonymous (logged-out, non-temporary) users | |
| * * CUDCOND_NAMED: allows specifying a default for named (registered, non-temporary) users | |
| * * CUDCOND_USERGROUP: users with a specific user group | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| * @see self::DefaultUserOptions | |
| */ | |
| public const ConditionalUserOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * An array of preferences to not show for the user | |
| */ | |
| public const HiddenPrefs = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Characters to prevent during new account creations. | |
| * | |
| * This is used in a regular expression character class during | |
| * registration (regex metacharacters like / are escaped). | |
| */ | |
| public const InvalidUsernameCharacters = [ | |
| 'default' => '@:>=', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Character used as a delimiter when testing for interwiki userrights | |
| * (In Special:UserRights, it is possible to modify users on different | |
| * databases if the delimiter is used, e.g. "Someuser@enwiki"). | |
| * | |
| * It is recommended that you have this delimiter in | |
| * $wgInvalidUsernameCharacters above, or you will not be able to | |
| * modify the user rights of those users via Special:UserRights | |
| */ | |
| public const UserrightsInterwikiDelimiter = [ | |
| 'default' => '@', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This is to let user authenticate using https when they come from http. | |
| * | |
| * Based on an idea by George Herbert on wikitech-l: | |
| * https://lists.wikimedia.org/pipermail/wikitech-l/2010-October/050039.html | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.17 | |
| */ | |
| public const SecureLogin = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Versioning for authentication tokens. | |
| * | |
| * If non-null, this is combined with the user's secret (the user_token field | |
| * in the DB) to generate the token cookie. Changing this will invalidate all | |
| * active sessions (i.e. it will log everyone out). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const AuthenticationTokenVersion = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * MediaWiki\Session\SessionProvider configuration. | |
| * | |
| * Values are ObjectFactory specifications for the SessionProviders to be | |
| * used. Keys in the array are ignored; the class name is conventionally | |
| * used as the key to avoid collisions. Order is not significant. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionProviders = [ | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| \MediaWiki\Session\CookieSessionProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => \MediaWiki\Session\CookieSessionProvider::class, | |
| 'args' => [ [ | |
| 'priority' => 30, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'JwtCodec', | |
| 'UrlUtils', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| \MediaWiki\Session\BotPasswordSessionProvider::class => [ | |
| 'class' => \MediaWiki\Session\BotPasswordSessionProvider::class, | |
| 'args' => [ [ | |
| 'priority' => 75, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'GrantsInfo' | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for automatic creation of temporary accounts on page save. | |
| * This can be enabled to avoid exposing the IP addresses of casual editors who | |
| * do not explicitly create an account. | |
| * | |
| * @warning This is EXPERIMENTAL, enabling may break extensions. | |
| * | |
| * An associative array with the following keys: | |
| * | |
| * - known: (bool) Whether auto-creation is known about. Set this to 'true' if | |
| * temp accounts have been created on this wiki already. This setting allows | |
| * temp users to be recognized even if auto-creation is currently disabled. | |
| * If auto-creation is enabled via the 'enabled' property, then 'known' is | |
| * overriden to true. | |
| * - enabled: (bool) Whether auto-creation is enabled. If changing this | |
| * value from 'true' to 'false', you should also set 'known' to true, so | |
| * that relevant code can continue to identify temporary accounts as | |
| * visually and conceptually distinct from anonymous accounts and named accounts. | |
| * Note that temporary account auto-creation is only actually enabled if | |
| * `*` group has the `createaccount` or `autocreateaccount` right. | |
| * - actions: (array) A list of actions for which the feature is enabled. | |
| * Currently only "edit" is supported. | |
| * - genPattern: (string) The pattern used when generating new usernames. | |
| * This should have "$1" indicating the place where the serial string will | |
| * be substituted. | |
| * - matchPattern: (string|string[]|null) The pattern used when determining whether a | |
| * username is a temporary user. This affects the rights of the user | |
| * and also prevents explicit creation of users with matching names. | |
| * This is ignored if "enabled" is false. If the value is null, the | |
| * the genPattern value is used as the matchPattern. | |
| * - reservedPattern: (string) A pattern used to determine whether a | |
| * username should be denied for explicit creation, in addition to | |
| * matchPattern. This is used even if "enabled" is false. | |
| * - serialProvider: (array) Configuration for generation of unique integer | |
| * indexes which are used to make temporary usernames. | |
| * - type: (string) May be "local" to allocate indexes using the local | |
| * database. If the CentralAuth extension is enabled, it may be | |
| * "centralauth". Extensions may plug in additional types using the | |
| * TempUserSerialProviders attribute. | |
| * - numShards (int, default 1): A small integer. This can be set to a | |
| * value greater than 1 to avoid acquiring a global lock when | |
| * allocating IDs, at the expense of making the IDs be non-monotonic. | |
| * - useYear: (bool) Restart at 1 each time the year changes (in UTC). | |
| * To avoid naming conflicts, the year is included in the name after | |
| * the prefix, in the form 'YYYY-'. | |
| * - serialMapping: (array) Configuration for mapping integer indexes to strings | |
| * to substitute into genPattern. | |
| * - type: (string) May be | |
| * - "readable-numeric" to use ASCII decimal numbers broken up with hyphens | |
| * - "plain-numeric" to use ASCII decimal numbers | |
| * - "localized-numeric" to use numbers localized using a specific language | |
| * - "filtered-radix" to use numbers in an arbitrary base between 2 and 36, | |
| * with an optional list of "bad" IDs to skip over. | |
| * - "scramble": to use ASCII decimal numbers that are short but | |
| * non-consecutive. | |
| * - language: (string) With "localized-numeric", the language code | |
| * - radix: (int) With "filtered-radix", the base | |
| * - badIndexes: (array) With "filtered-radix", an array with the bad unmapped | |
| * indexes in the values. The integers must be sorted and the list | |
| * must never change after the indexes have been allocated. The keys must | |
| * be zero-based array indexes. | |
| * - uppercase: (bool) With "filtered-radix", whether to use uppercase | |
| * letters, default false. | |
| * - offset: (int) With "plain-numeric" and "readable-numeric", a constant to add to the | |
| * stored index. | |
| * - expireAfterDays: (int|null, default 90) If not null, how many days should the temporary | |
| * accounts expire? You should run expireTemporaryAccounts.php periodically to expire | |
| * temporary accounts. Otherwise they are expired when they try to edit. | |
| * - notifyBeforeExpirationDays: (int|null, default 10) If not null, how many days before the | |
| * expiration of a temporary account should it be notified that their account is to be expired. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.39 | |
| */ | |
| public const AutoCreateTempUser = [ | |
| 'properties' => [ | |
| 'known' => [ 'type' => 'bool', 'default' => false ], | |
| 'enabled' => [ 'type' => 'bool', 'default' => false ], | |
| 'actions' => [ 'type' => 'list', 'default' => [ 'edit' ] ], | |
| 'genPattern' => [ 'type' => 'string', 'default' => '~$1' ], | |
| 'matchPattern' => [ 'type' => 'string|array|null', 'default' => null ], | |
| 'reservedPattern' => [ 'type' => 'string|null', 'default' => '~$1' ], | |
| 'serialProvider' => [ 'type' => 'object', 'default' => [ 'type' => 'local', 'useYear' => true ] ], | |
| 'serialMapping' => [ 'type' => 'object', 'default' => [ 'type' => 'readable-numeric' ] ], | |
| 'expireAfterDays' => [ 'type' => 'int|null', 'default' => 90 ], | |
| 'notifyBeforeExpirationDays' => [ 'type' => 'int|null', 'default' => 10 ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end user accounts | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region User rights, access control and monitoring | |
| /** @name User rights, access control and monitoring */ | |
| /** List of IP addresses or CIDR ranges that are exempt from autoblocks. */ | |
| public const AutoblockExemptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'array', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of seconds before autoblock entries expire. Default 86400 = 1 day. | |
| */ | |
| public const AutoblockExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 86400, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true to allow blocked users to edit their own user talk page. | |
| * | |
| * This only applies to sitewide blocks. Partial blocks always allow users to | |
| * edit their own user talk page unless otherwise specified in the block | |
| * restrictions. | |
| */ | |
| public const BlockAllowsUTEdit = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Limits on the possible sizes of range blocks. | |
| * | |
| * CIDR notation is hard to understand, it's easy to mistakenly assume that a | |
| * /1 is a small range and a /31 is a large range. For IPv4, setting a limit of | |
| * half the number of bits avoids such errors, and allows entire ISPs to be | |
| * blocked using a small number of range blocks. | |
| * | |
| * For IPv6, RFC 3177 recommends that a /48 be allocated to every residential | |
| * customer, so range blocks larger than /64 (half the number of bits) will | |
| * plainly be required. RFC 4692 implies that a very large ISP may be | |
| * allocated a /19 if a generous HD-Ratio of 0.8 is used, so we will use that | |
| * as our limit. As of 2012, blocking the whole world would require a /4 range. | |
| */ | |
| public const BlockCIDRLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'IPv4' => 16, | |
| 'IPv6' => 19, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, sitewide blocked users will not be allowed to login. (Direct | |
| * blocks only; IP blocks are ignored.) This can be used to remove users' | |
| * read access on a private wiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const BlockDisablesLogin = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this is false, the number of blocks of a given target is limited to only 1. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableMultiBlocks = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Ipblocks table schema migration stage, for normalizing ipb_address field and | |
| * adding the block_target table. | |
| * | |
| * Use the SCHEMA_COMPAT_XXX flags. Supported values: | |
| * | |
| * - SCHEMA_COMPAT_OLD | |
| * - SCHEMA_COMPAT_WRITE_BOTH | SCHEMA_COMPAT_READ_OLD | |
| * - SCHEMA_COMPAT_NEW | |
| * | |
| * History: | |
| * - 1.42: Added | |
| * - 1.43: Default changed from SCHEMA_COMPAT_OLD to SCHEMA_COMPAT_NEW | |
| * - 1.43: Deprecated, ignored, SCHEMA_COMPAT_NEW is implied | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const BlockTargetMigrationStage = [ | |
| 'default' => SCHEMA_COMPAT_NEW, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Pages anonymous user may see, set as an array of pages titles. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgWhitelistRead = [ "Main Page", "Wikipedia:Help" ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Special:Userlogin and Special:ChangePassword are always allowed. | |
| * | |
| * @note This will only work if $wgGroupPermissions['*']['read'] is false -- | |
| * see below. Otherwise, ALL pages are accessible, regardless of this setting. | |
| * @note Also that this will only protect _pages in the wiki_. Uploaded files | |
| * will remain readable. You can use img_auth.php to protect uploaded files, | |
| * see https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:Image_Authorization | |
| * @note Extensions should not modify this, but use the TitleReadWhitelist | |
| * hook instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const WhitelistRead = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Pages anonymous user may see, set as an array of regular expressions. | |
| * | |
| * This function will match the regexp against the title name, which | |
| * is without underscore. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * To whitelist [[Main Page]]: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgWhitelistReadRegexp = [ "/Main Page/" ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * @note Unless ^ and/or $ is specified, a regular expression might match | |
| * pages not intended to be allowed. The above example will also | |
| * allow a page named 'Security Main Page'. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * To allow reading any page starting with 'User' regardless of the case: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgWhitelistReadRegexp = [ "@^UsEr.*@i" ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Will allow both [[User is banned]] and [[User:JohnDoe]] | |
| * @note This will only work if $wgGroupPermissions['*']['read'] is false -- | |
| * see below. Otherwise, ALL pages are accessible, regardless of this setting. | |
| */ | |
| public const WhitelistReadRegexp = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Should editors be required to have a validated e-mail | |
| * address before being allowed to edit? | |
| */ | |
| public const EmailConfirmToEdit = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Should MediaWiki attempt to protect user's privacy when doing redirects? | |
| * Keep this true if access counts to articles are made public. | |
| */ | |
| public const HideIdentifiableRedirects = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Permission keys given to users in each group. | |
| * | |
| * This is an array where the keys are all groups and each value is an | |
| * array of the format (right => boolean). | |
| * | |
| * The second format is used to support per-namespace permissions. | |
| * Note that this feature does not fully work for all permission types. | |
| * | |
| * All users are implicitly in the '*' group including anonymous visitors; | |
| * logged-in users are all implicitly in the 'user' group. These will be | |
| * combined with the permissions of all groups that a given user is listed | |
| * in the user_groups table. | |
| * | |
| * Note: Don't set $wgGroupPermissions = []; unless you know what you're | |
| * doing! This will wipe all permissions, and may mean that your users are | |
| * unable to perform certain essential tasks or access new functionality | |
| * when new permissions are introduced and default grants established. | |
| * | |
| * Functionality to make pages inaccessible has not been extensively tested | |
| * for security. Use at your own risk! | |
| * | |
| * This replaces $wgWhitelistAccount and $wgWhitelistEdit | |
| */ | |
| public const GroupPermissions = [ | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'boolean', ], | |
| ], | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| '*' => [ | |
| 'createaccount' => true, | |
| 'read' => true, | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'createpage' => true, | |
| 'createtalk' => true, | |
| 'viewmyprivateinfo' => true, | |
| 'editmyprivateinfo' => true, | |
| 'editmyoptions' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'user' => [ | |
| 'move' => true, | |
| 'move-subpages' => true, | |
| 'move-rootuserpages' => true, | |
| 'move-categorypages' => true, | |
| 'movefile' => true, | |
| 'read' => true, | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'createpage' => true, | |
| 'createtalk' => true, | |
| 'upload' => true, | |
| 'reupload' => true, | |
| 'reupload-shared' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'editmyusercss' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjson' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjs' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjsredirect' => true, | |
| 'sendemail' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'viewmywatchlist' => true, | |
| 'editmywatchlist' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => [ | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => true, | |
| 'editsemiprotected' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'bot' => [ | |
| 'bot' => true, | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => true, | |
| 'editsemiprotected' => true, | |
| 'nominornewtalk' => true, | |
| 'autopatrol' => true, | |
| 'suppressredirect' => true, | |
| 'apihighlimits' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'sysop' => [ | |
| 'block' => true, | |
| 'createaccount' => true, | |
| 'delete' => true, | |
| 'bigdelete' => true, | |
| 'deletedhistory' => true, | |
| 'deletedtext' => true, | |
| 'undelete' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editinterface' => true, | |
| 'editsitejson' => true, | |
| 'edituserjson' => true, | |
| 'import' => true, | |
| 'importupload' => true, | |
| 'move' => true, | |
| 'move-subpages' => true, | |
| 'move-rootuserpages' => true, | |
| 'move-categorypages' => true, | |
| 'patrol' => true, | |
| 'autopatrol' => true, | |
| 'protect' => true, | |
| 'editprotected' => true, | |
| 'rollback' => true, | |
| 'upload' => true, | |
| 'reupload' => true, | |
| 'reupload-shared' => true, | |
| 'unwatchedpages' => true, | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => true, | |
| 'editsemiprotected' => true, | |
| 'ipblock-exempt' => true, | |
| 'blockemail' => true, | |
| 'markbotedits' => true, | |
| 'apihighlimits' => true, | |
| 'browsearchive' => true, | |
| 'noratelimit' => true, | |
| 'movefile' => true, | |
| 'unblockself' => true, | |
| 'suppressredirect' => true, | |
| 'mergehistory' => true, | |
| 'managechangetags' => true, | |
| 'deletechangetags' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'interface-admin' => [ | |
| 'editinterface' => true, | |
| 'editsitecss' => true, | |
| 'editsitejson' => true, | |
| 'editsitejs' => true, | |
| 'editusercss' => true, | |
| 'edituserjson' => true, | |
| 'edituserjs' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'bureaucrat' => [ | |
| 'userrights' => true, | |
| 'noratelimit' => true, | |
| 'renameuser' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'suppress' => [ | |
| 'hideuser' => true, | |
| 'suppressrevision' => true, | |
| 'viewsuppressed' => true, | |
| 'suppressionlog' => true, | |
| 'deleterevision' => true, | |
| 'deletelogentry' => true, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of groups which should be considered privileged (user accounts | |
| * belonging in these groups can be abused in dangerous ways). | |
| * This is used for some security checks, mainly logging. | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\User\UserGroupManager::getUserPrivilegedGroups() | |
| */ | |
| public const PrivilegedGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'bureaucrat', | |
| 'interface-admin', | |
| 'suppress', | |
| 'sysop', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Permission keys revoked from users in each group. | |
| * | |
| * This acts the same way as $wgGroupPermissions above, except that | |
| * if the user is in a group here, the permission will be removed from them. | |
| * | |
| * Improperly setting this could mean that your users will be unable to perform | |
| * certain essential tasks, so use at your own risk! | |
| */ | |
| public const RevokePermissions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Groups that should inherit permissions from another group | |
| * | |
| * This allows defining a group that inherits its permissions | |
| * from another group without having to copy all the permission | |
| * grants over. For example, if you wanted a manual "confirmed" | |
| * group that had the same permissions as "autoconfirmed": | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgGroupInheritsPermissions['confirmed'] = 'autoconfirmed'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Recursive inheritance is currently not supported. In the above | |
| * example, confirmed will only gain the permissions explicitly | |
| * granted (or revoked) from autoconfirmed, not any permissions | |
| * that autoconfirmed might inherit. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const GroupInheritsPermissions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Implicit groups, aren't shown on Special:Listusers or somewhere else | |
| */ | |
| public const ImplicitGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [ '*', 'user', 'autoconfirmed' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A map of group names that the user is in, to group names that those users | |
| * are allowed to add or revoke. | |
| * | |
| * Setting the list of groups to add or revoke to true is equivalent to "any | |
| * group". | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * To allow sysops to add themselves to the "bot" group: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgGroupsAddToSelf = [ 'sysop' => [ 'bot' ] ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Implicit groups may be used for the source group, for instance: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgGroupsRemoveFromSelf = [ '*' => true ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * This allows users in the '*' group (i.e. any user) to remove themselves from | |
| * any group that they happen to be in. | |
| */ | |
| public const GroupsAddToSelf = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::GroupsAddToSelf | |
| */ | |
| public const GroupsRemoveFromSelf = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set of available actions that can be restricted via action=protect | |
| * You probably shouldn't change this. | |
| * | |
| * Translated through restriction-* messages. | |
| * RestrictionStore::listApplicableRestrictionTypes() will remove restrictions that are not | |
| * applicable to a specific title (create and upload) | |
| */ | |
| public const RestrictionTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'create', 'edit', 'move', 'upload' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Rights which can be required for each protection level (via action=protect) | |
| * | |
| * You can add a new protection level that requires a specific | |
| * permission by manipulating this array. The ordering of elements | |
| * dictates the order on the protection form's lists. | |
| * | |
| * - '' will be ignored (i.e. unprotected) | |
| * - 'autoconfirmed' is quietly rewritten to 'editsemiprotected' for backwards compatibility | |
| * - 'sysop' is quietly rewritten to 'editprotected' for backwards compatibility | |
| */ | |
| public const RestrictionLevels = [ | |
| 'default' => [ '', 'autoconfirmed', 'sysop' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Restriction levels that can be used with cascading protection | |
| * | |
| * A page can only be protected with cascading protection if the | |
| * requested restriction level is included in this array. | |
| * | |
| * 'autoconfirmed' is quietly rewritten to 'editsemiprotected' for backwards compatibility. | |
| * 'sysop' is quietly rewritten to 'editprotected' for backwards compatibility. | |
| */ | |
| public const CascadingRestrictionLevels = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'sysop', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Restriction levels that should be considered "semiprotected" | |
| * | |
| * Certain places in the interface recognize a dichotomy between "protected" | |
| * and "semiprotected", without further distinguishing the specific levels. In | |
| * general, if anyone can be eligible to edit a protection level merely by | |
| * reaching some condition in $wgAutopromote, it should probably be considered | |
| * "semiprotected". | |
| * | |
| * 'autoconfirmed' is quietly rewritten to 'editsemiprotected' for backwards compatibility. | |
| * 'sysop' is not changed, since it really shouldn't be here. | |
| */ | |
| public const SemiprotectedRestrictionLevels = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'autoconfirmed', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set the minimum permissions required to edit pages in each | |
| * namespace. If you list more than one permission, a user must | |
| * have all of them to edit pages in that namespace. | |
| * | |
| * @note NS_MEDIAWIKI is implicitly restricted to 'editinterface'. | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespaceProtection = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Pages in namespaces in this array can not be used as templates. | |
| * | |
| * Elements MUST be numeric namespace ids, you can safely use the MediaWiki | |
| * namespaces constants (NS_USER, NS_MAIN...). | |
| * | |
| * Among other things, this may be useful to enforce read-restrictions | |
| * which may otherwise be bypassed by using the template mechanism. | |
| */ | |
| public const NonincludableNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of seconds an account is required to age before it's given the | |
| * implicit 'autoconfirm' group membership. This can be used to limit | |
| * privileges of new accounts. | |
| * | |
| * Accounts created by earlier versions of the software may not have a | |
| * recorded creation date, and will always be considered to pass the age test. | |
| * | |
| * When left at 0, all registered accounts will pass. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Set automatic confirmation to 10 minutes (which is 600 seconds): | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAutoConfirmAge = 600; // ten minutes | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Set age to one day: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAutoConfirmAge = 3600*24; // one day | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const AutoConfirmAge = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of edits an account requires before it is autoconfirmed. | |
| * | |
| * Passing both this AND the time requirement is needed. Example: | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAutoConfirmCount = 50; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const AutoConfirmCount = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array containing the conditions of automatic promotion of a user to specific groups. | |
| * | |
| * The basic syntax for `$wgAutopromote` is: | |
| * | |
| * $wgAutopromote = [ | |
| * 'groupname' => cond, | |
| * 'group2' => cond2, | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * A `cond` may be: | |
| * - a single condition without arguments: | |
| * Note that Autopromote wraps a single non-array value into an array | |
| * e.g. `APCOND_EMAILCONFIRMED` OR | |
| * [ `APCOND_EMAILCONFIRMED` ] | |
| * - a single condition with arguments: | |
| * e.g. `[ APCOND_EDITCOUNT, 100 ]` | |
| * - a set of conditions: | |
| * e.g. `[ 'operand', cond1, cond2, ... ]` | |
| * | |
| * When constructing a set of conditions, the following conditions are available: | |
| * - `&` (**AND**): | |
| * promote if user matches **ALL** conditions | |
| * - `|` (**OR**): | |
| * promote if user matches **ANY** condition | |
| * - `^` (**XOR**): | |
| * promote if user matches **ONLY ONE OF THE CONDITIONS** | |
| * - `!` (**NOT**): | |
| * promote if user matces **NO** condition | |
| * - [ APCOND_EMAILCONFIRMED ]: | |
| * true if user has a confirmed e-mail | |
| * - [ APCOND_EDITCOUNT, number of edits (if null or missing $wgAutoConfirmCount will be used)]: | |
| * true if user has the at least the number of edits as the passed parameter | |
| * - [ APCOND_AGE, seconds since registration (if null or missing $wgAutoConfirmAge will be used)]: | |
| * true if the length of time since the user created their account | |
| * is at least the same length of time as the passed parameter | |
| * - [ APCOND_AGE_FROM_EDIT, seconds since first edit ]: | |
| * true if the length of time since the user made their first edit | |
| * is at least the same length of time as the passed parameter | |
| * - [ APCOND_INGROUPS, group1, group2, ... ]: | |
| * true if the user is a member of each of the passed groups | |
| * - [ APCOND_ISIP, ip ]: | |
| * true if the user has the passed IP address | |
| * - [ APCOND_IPINRANGE, range ]: | |
| * true if the user has an IP address in the range of the passed parameter | |
| * - [ APCOND_BLOCKED ]: | |
| * true if the user is sitewide blocked | |
| * - [ APCOND_ISBOT ]: | |
| * true if the user is a bot | |
| * - similar constructs can be defined by extensions | |
| * | |
| * The sets of conditions are evaluated recursively, so you can use nested sets of conditions | |
| * linked by operands. | |
| * | |
| * Note that if $wgEmailAuthentication is disabled, APCOND_EMAILCONFIRMED will be true for any | |
| * user who has provided an e-mail address. | |
| */ | |
| public const Autopromote = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => [ '&', | |
| [ APCOND_EDITCOUNT, null ], // NOTE: null means $wgAutoConfirmCount | |
| [ APCOND_AGE, null ], // NOTE: null means AutoConfirmAge | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Automatically add a usergroup to any user who matches certain conditions. | |
| * | |
| * Does not add the user to the group again if it has been removed. | |
| * Also, does not remove the group if the user no longer meets the criteria. | |
| * | |
| * The format is: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * [ event => criteria, ... ] | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * The only recognised value for event is 'onEdit' (when the user edits). | |
| * | |
| * Criteria has the same format as $wgAutopromote | |
| * | |
| * @see self::Autopromote | |
| * @since 1.18 | |
| */ | |
| public const AutopromoteOnce = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'onEdit' => [], ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Put user rights log entries for autopromotion in recent changes? | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.18 | |
| */ | |
| public const AutopromoteOnceLogInRC = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Defines a denylist of group names. One-shot autopromotions into these groups will not cause a | |
| * RecentChanges entry to be inserted even if AutopromoteOnceLogInRC is set, as long as they are the | |
| * only new groups the user was autopromoted to. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.44 | |
| */ | |
| public const AutopromoteOnceRCExcludedGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'array', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * $wgAddGroups and $wgRemoveGroups can be used to give finer control over who | |
| * can assign which groups at Special:Userrights. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Bureaucrats can add any group: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAddGroups['bureaucrat'] = true; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Bureaucrats can only remove bots and sysops: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRemoveGroups['bureaucrat'] = [ 'bot', 'sysop' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Sysops can make bots: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAddGroups['sysop'] = [ 'bot' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Sysops can disable other sysops in an emergency, and disable bots: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRemoveGroups['sysop'] = [ 'sysop', 'bot' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const AddGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_merge_recursive', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @see self::AddGroups | |
| */ | |
| public const RemoveGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_merge_recursive', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A list of available rights, in addition to the ones defined by the core. | |
| * Rights in this list are denied unless explicitly granted, typically | |
| * using GroupPermissions. | |
| * | |
| * For extensions only. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::GroupPermissions | |
| * @see self::ImplicitRights | |
| */ | |
| public const AvailableRights = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A list of implicit rights, in addition to the ones defined by the core. | |
| * Rights in this list are granted implicitly to all users, but rate limits | |
| * may apply to them. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions that define rate limits should add the corresponding right to | |
| * either ImplicitRights or AvailableRights, depending on whether the right | |
| * should be granted to everyone. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| * @see self::RateLimits | |
| * @see self::AvailableRights | |
| */ | |
| public const ImplicitRights = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Optional to restrict deletion of pages with higher revision counts | |
| * to users with the 'bigdelete' permission. (Default given to sysops.) | |
| */ | |
| public const DeleteRevisionsLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Page deletions with > this number of revisions will use the job queue. | |
| * | |
| * Revisions will be archived in batches of (at most) this size, one batch per job. | |
| */ | |
| public const DeleteRevisionsBatchSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 1000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum number of edits a user can have and | |
| * can still be hidden by users with the hideuser permission. | |
| * | |
| * This is limited for performance reason. | |
| * Set to false to disable the limit. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const HideUserContribLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 1000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of accounts each IP address may create per specified period(s). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAccountCreationThrottle = [ | |
| * // no more than 100 per month | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 100, | |
| * 'seconds' => 30*86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * // no more than 10 per day | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 10, | |
| * 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @note For backwards compatibility reasons, this may also be given as a single | |
| * integer, representing the number of account creations per day. | |
| * @see self::TempAccountCreationThrottle for the temporary accounts version of | |
| * this throttle | |
| * @warning Requires $wgMainCacheType to be enabled | |
| */ | |
| public const AccountCreationThrottle = [ | |
| 'default' => [ [ | |
| 'count' => 0, | |
| 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'type' => 'int|list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of temporary accounts each IP address may create per specified period(s). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgTempAccountCreationThrottle = [ | |
| * // no more than 100 per month | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 100, | |
| * 'seconds' => 30*86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * // no more than 6 per day | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 6, | |
| * 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @see self::AccountCreationThrottle for the regular account version of this throttle. | |
| * @warning Requires $wgMainCacheType to be enabled | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const TempAccountCreationThrottle = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| [ | |
| 'count' => 1, | |
| 'seconds' => 600, | |
| ], | |
| [ | |
| 'count' => 6, | |
| 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of temporary accounts usernames each IP address may acquire per specified period(s). | |
| * | |
| * This should be set to a higher value than TempAccountCreationThrottle. | |
| * | |
| * On editing, we first attempt to acquire a temp username before proceeding with saving an edit | |
| * and potentially creating a temp account if the edit save is successful. | |
| * | |
| * Some edits may fail (due to core or extensions denying an edit); this throttle ensures that | |
| * there are limits to the number of temporary account names that can be acquired and stored in | |
| * the database. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgTempAccountNameAcquisitionThrottle = [ | |
| * // no more than 100 per month | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 100, | |
| * 'seconds' => 30*86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * // no more than 60 per day | |
| * [ | |
| * 'count' => 60, | |
| * 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @see self::TempAccountCreationThrottle Make sure that TempAccountNameAcquisitionThrottle is greater than or | |
| * equal to TempAccountCreationThrottle | |
| * @warning Requires $wgMainCacheType to be enabled | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const TempAccountNameAcquisitionThrottle = [ | |
| 'default' => [ [ | |
| 'count' => 60, | |
| 'seconds' => 86400, | |
| ] ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Edits matching these regular expressions in body text | |
| * will be recognised as spam and rejected automatically. | |
| * | |
| * There's no administrator override on-wiki, so be careful what you set. :) | |
| * May be an array of regexes or a single string for backwards compatibility. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Regular_expression | |
| * @note Each regex needs a beginning/end delimiter, eg: # or / | |
| */ | |
| public const SpamRegex = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Same as SpamRegex except for edit summaries | |
| */ | |
| public const SummarySpamRegex = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use DNS blacklists in $wgDnsBlacklistUrls to check for open | |
| * proxies | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableDnsBlacklist = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of DNS blacklists to use, if $wgEnableDnsBlacklist is true. | |
| * | |
| * This is an array of either a URL or an array with the URL and a key (should | |
| * the blacklist require a key). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDnsBlacklistUrls = [ | |
| * // String containing URL | |
| * 'http.dnsbl.sorbs.net.', | |
| * // Array with URL and key, for services that require a key | |
| * [ 'dnsbl.httpbl.net.', 'mykey' ], | |
| * // Array with just the URL. While this works, it is recommended that you | |
| * // just use a string as shown above | |
| * [ 'opm.tornevall.org.' ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @note You should end the domain name with a . to avoid searching your | |
| * eventual domain search suffixes. | |
| * @since 1.16 | |
| */ | |
| public const DnsBlacklistUrls = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of banned IP addresses. | |
| * | |
| * This can have the following formats: | |
| * - An array of addresses | |
| * - A string, in which case this is the path to a file | |
| * containing the list of IP addresses, one per line | |
| */ | |
| public const ProxyList = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'string|list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Proxy whitelist, list of addresses that are assumed to be non-proxy despite | |
| * what the other methods might say. | |
| */ | |
| public const ProxyWhitelist = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * IP ranges that should be considered soft-blocked (anon-only, account | |
| * creation allowed). The intent is to use this to prevent anonymous edits from | |
| * shared resources such as Wikimedia Labs. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.29 | |
| */ | |
| public const SoftBlockRanges = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'items' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to look at the X-Forwarded-For header's list of (potentially spoofed) | |
| * IPs and apply IP blocks to them. This allows for IP blocks to work with correctly-configured | |
| * (transparent) proxies without needing to block the proxies themselves. | |
| */ | |
| public const ApplyIpBlocksToXff = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Simple rate limiter options to brake edit floods. | |
| * | |
| * Maximum number actions allowed in the given number of seconds; after that | |
| * the violating client receives HTTP 500 error pages until the period | |
| * elapses. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Limits per configured per action and then type of users. | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRateLimits = [ | |
| * 'edit' => [ | |
| * 'anon' => [ x, y ], // any and all anonymous edits (aggregate) | |
| * 'user' => [ x, y ], // each logged-in user | |
| * 'user-global' => [ x, y ], // per username, across all sites (assumes names are | |
| * global) | |
| * 'newbie' => [ x, y ], // each new autoconfirmed accounts; overrides 'user' | |
| * 'ip' => [ x, y ], // each anon and recent account, across all sites | |
| * 'subnet' => [ x, y ], // ... within a /24 subnet in IPv4 or /64 in IPv6 | |
| * 'ip-all' => [ x, y ], // per ip, across all sites | |
| * 'subnet-all' => [ x, y ], // ... within a /24 subnet in IPv4 or /64 in IPv6 | |
| * 'groupName' => [ x, y ], // by group membership | |
| * ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Normally, the 'noratelimit' right allows a user to bypass any rate** | |
| * limit checks. This can be disabled on a per-action basis by setting the | |
| * special '&can-bypass' key to false in that action's configuration. | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRateLimits = [ | |
| * 'some-action' => [ | |
| * '&can-bypass' => false, | |
| * 'user' => [ x, y ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @see self::ImplicitRights | |
| * @warning Requires that $wgMainCacheType is set to something persistent | |
| */ | |
| public const RateLimits = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| // Page edits | |
| 'edit' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 90, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Page moves | |
| 'move' => [ | |
| 'newbie' => [ 2, 120 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // File uploads | |
| 'upload' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Page rollbacks | |
| 'rollback' => [ | |
| 'user' => [ 10, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 5, 120 ] | |
| ], | |
| // Triggering password resets emails | |
| 'mailpassword' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 5, 3600 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Emailing other users using MediaWiki | |
| 'sendemail' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 5, 86400 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 5, 86400 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 20, 86400 ], | |
| ], | |
| 'changeemail' => [ | |
| 'ip-all' => [ 10, 3600 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 4, 86400 ] | |
| ], | |
| // since 1.33 - rate limit email confirmations | |
| 'confirmemail' => [ | |
| 'ip-all' => [ 10, 3600 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 4, 86400 ] | |
| ], | |
| // Purging pages | |
| 'purge' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Purges of link tables | |
| 'linkpurge' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Files rendered via thumb.php or thumb_handler.php | |
| 'renderfile' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 700, 30 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 700, 30 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Same as above but for non-standard thumbnails | |
| 'renderfile-nonstandard' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 70, 30 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 70, 30 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Stashing edits into cache before save | |
| 'stashedit' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 30, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Stash base HTML for VE edits | |
| 'stashbasehtml' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 5, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 5, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Adding or removing change tags | |
| 'changetags' => [ | |
| 'ip' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| 'newbie' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| // Changing the content model of a page | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => [ | |
| 'newbie' => [ 2, 120 ], | |
| 'user' => [ 8, 60 ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of IPs / CIDR ranges which should be excluded from rate limits. | |
| * | |
| * This may be useful for allowing NAT gateways for conferences, etc. | |
| */ | |
| public const RateLimitsExcludedIPs = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Log IP addresses in the recentchanges table; can be accessed only by | |
| * extensions (e.g. CheckUser) or a DB admin | |
| * Used for retroactive autoblocks | |
| */ | |
| public const PutIPinRC = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Integer defining default number of entries to show on | |
| * special pages which are query-pages such as Special:Whatlinkshere. | |
| */ | |
| public const QueryPageDefaultLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 50, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for external query sources. | |
| * | |
| * This allows system administrators to off-load expensive QueryPage subclasses | |
| * to alternative query sources by fetching results over HTTP. | |
| * For example, you might periodically run your own version of a query via Hadoop, | |
| * and serve the result as a JSON file from a static HTTP server (T309738). | |
| * | |
| * While your external source will likely be a static file serving cached | |
| * results, MediaWiki will treat this external source as drop-in replacement | |
| * for the database, not as replacement for the cache. | |
| * | |
| * This means if you enable $wgMiserMode, your external service does not | |
| * require high-availabilty and high-traffic support because you still benefit | |
| * from persistent cache (in the querycache table) and offline pull (via | |
| * maintenance/updateSpecialPages.php, instead of a live user request). | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ```php | |
| * $wgExternalQuerySources = [ | |
| * 'Mostlinkedtemplates' => [ | |
| * 'enabled' => true, | |
| * 'url' => 'https://example.org/data/Mostlinkedtemplates.json', | |
| * 'timeout' => 10, // seconds, optional | |
| * ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExternalQuerySources = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| 'properties' => [ | |
| 'enabled' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ], | |
| 'url' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| 'format' => 'uri', | |
| ], | |
| 'timeout' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'required' => [ 'enabled', 'url' ], | |
| 'additionalProperties' => false, | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Limit password attempts to X attempts per Y seconds per IP per account. | |
| * | |
| * Value is an array of arrays. Each sub-array must have a key for count | |
| * (ie count of how many attempts before throttle) and a key for seconds. | |
| * If the key 'allIPs' (case sensitive) is present, then the limit is | |
| * just per account instead of per IP per account. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 allIps support and multiple limits added in 1.27. Prior | |
| * to 1.27 this only supported having a single throttle. | |
| * @warning Requires $wgMainCacheType to be enabled | |
| */ | |
| public const PasswordAttemptThrottle = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| // Short term limit | |
| [ 'count' => 5, 'seconds' => 300 ], | |
| // Long term limit. We need to balance the risk | |
| // of somebody using this as a DoS attack to lock someone | |
| // out of their account, and someone doing a brute force attack. | |
| [ 'count' => 150, 'seconds' => 60 * 60 * 48 ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Users authorize consumers (like Apps) to act on their behalf but only with | |
| * a subset of the user's normal account rights (signed off on by the user). | |
| * The possible rights to grant to a consumer are bundled into groups called | |
| * "grants". Each grant defines some rights it lets consumers inherit from the | |
| * account they may act on behalf of. Note that a user granting a right does | |
| * nothing if that user does not actually have that right to begin with. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const GrantPermissions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'basic' => [ | |
| 'autocreateaccount' => true, | |
| 'autoconfirmed' => true, | |
| 'autopatrol' => true, | |
| 'editsemiprotected' => true, | |
| 'ipblock-exempt' => true, | |
| 'nominornewtalk' => true, | |
| 'patrolmarks' => true, | |
| 'read' => true, | |
| 'unwatchedpages' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'highvolume' => [ | |
| 'bot' => true, | |
| 'apihighlimits' => true, | |
| 'noratelimit' => true, | |
| 'markbotedits' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'import' => [ | |
| 'import' => true, | |
| 'importupload' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editpage' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'pagelang' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editprotected' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editprotected' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editmycssjs' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editmyusercss' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjson' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjs' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editmyoptions' => [ | |
| 'editmyoptions' => true, | |
| 'editmyuserjson' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editinterface' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editinterface' => true, | |
| 'edituserjson' => true, | |
| 'editsitejson' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editsiteconfig' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editinterface' => true, | |
| 'edituserjson' => true, | |
| 'editsitejson' => true, | |
| 'editusercss' => true, | |
| 'edituserjs' => true, | |
| 'editsitecss' => true, | |
| 'editsitejs' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'createeditmovepage' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'createpage' => true, | |
| 'createtalk' => true, | |
| 'delete-redirect' => true, | |
| 'move' => true, | |
| 'move-rootuserpages' => true, | |
| 'move-subpages' => true, | |
| 'move-categorypages' => true, | |
| 'suppressredirect' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'uploadfile' => [ | |
| 'upload' => true, | |
| 'reupload-own' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'uploadeditmovefile' => [ | |
| 'upload' => true, | |
| 'reupload-own' => true, | |
| 'reupload' => true, | |
| 'reupload-shared' => true, | |
| 'upload_by_url' => true, | |
| 'movefile' => true, | |
| 'suppressredirect' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'patrol' => [ | |
| 'patrol' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'rollback' => [ | |
| 'rollback' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'blockusers' => [ | |
| 'block' => true, | |
| 'blockemail' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'viewdeleted' => [ | |
| 'browsearchive' => true, | |
| 'deletedhistory' => true, | |
| 'deletedtext' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'viewrestrictedlogs' => [ | |
| 'suppressionlog' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'delete' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'browsearchive' => true, | |
| 'deletedhistory' => true, | |
| 'deletedtext' => true, | |
| 'delete' => true, | |
| 'bigdelete' => true, | |
| 'deletelogentry' => true, | |
| 'deleterevision' => true, | |
| 'undelete' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'oversight' => [ | |
| 'suppressrevision' => true, | |
| 'viewsuppressed' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'protect' => [ | |
| 'edit' => true, | |
| 'minoredit' => true, | |
| 'applychangetags' => true, | |
| 'changetags' => true, | |
| 'editcontentmodel' => true, | |
| 'editprotected' => true, | |
| 'protect' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'viewmywatchlist' => [ | |
| 'viewmywatchlist' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'editmywatchlist' => [ | |
| 'editmywatchlist' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'sendemail' => [ | |
| 'sendemail' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'createaccount' => [ | |
| 'createaccount' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'privateinfo' => [ | |
| 'viewmyprivateinfo' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'mergehistory' => [ | |
| 'mergehistory' => true, | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'boolean', ], | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Grant groups are used on some user interfaces to display conceptually | |
| * similar grants together. | |
| * | |
| * This configuration value should usually be set by extensions, not | |
| * site administrators. | |
| * | |
| * @see self::GrantPermissions | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const GrantPermissionGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => | |
| [ | |
| // Hidden grants are implicitly present | |
| 'basic' => 'hidden', | |
| 'editpage' => 'page-interaction', | |
| 'createeditmovepage' => 'page-interaction', | |
| 'editprotected' => 'page-interaction', | |
| 'patrol' => 'page-interaction', | |
| 'uploadfile' => 'file-interaction', | |
| 'uploadeditmovefile' => 'file-interaction', | |
| 'sendemail' => 'email', | |
| 'viewmywatchlist' => 'watchlist-interaction', | |
| 'editviewmywatchlist' => 'watchlist-interaction', | |
| 'editmycssjs' => 'customization', | |
| 'editmyoptions' => 'customization', | |
| 'editinterface' => 'administration', | |
| 'editsiteconfig' => 'administration', | |
| 'rollback' => 'administration', | |
| 'blockusers' => 'administration', | |
| 'delete' => 'administration', | |
| 'viewdeleted' => 'administration', | |
| 'viewrestrictedlogs' => 'administration', | |
| 'protect' => 'administration', | |
| 'oversight' => 'administration', | |
| 'createaccount' => 'administration', | |
| 'mergehistory' => 'administration', | |
| 'import' => 'administration', | |
| 'highvolume' => 'high-volume', | |
| 'privateinfo' => 'private-information', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'string', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Group grants by risk level. Keys are grant names (i.e. keys from GrantPermissions), | |
| * values are GrantsInfo::RISK_* constants. | |
| * | |
| * Note that this classification is only informative; merely applying 'security' or 'internal' | |
| * to a grant won't prevent it from being available. It's used to give guidance to users | |
| * in various interfaces about the riskiness of the various grants. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const GrantRiskGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'basic' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'editpage' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'createeditmovepage' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'editprotected' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'patrol' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'uploadfile' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'uploadeditmovefile' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'sendemail' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'viewmywatchlist' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'editviewmywatchlist' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'editmycssjs' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'editmyoptions' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'editinterface' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'editsiteconfig' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'rollback' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'blockusers' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'delete' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'viewdeleted' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'viewrestrictedlogs' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'protect' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'oversight' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'createaccount' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'mergehistory' => GrantsInfo::RISK_VANDALISM, | |
| 'import' => GrantsInfo::RISK_SECURITY, | |
| 'highvolume' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| 'privateinfo' => GrantsInfo::RISK_LOW, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableBotPasswords = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Cluster for the bot_passwords table | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| * @deprecated since 1.42 Use $wgVirtualDomainsMapping instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const BotPasswordsCluster = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Database name for the bot_passwords table | |
| * | |
| * To use a database with a table prefix, set this variable to | |
| * "{$database}-{$prefix}". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| * @deprecated since 1.42 Use $wgVirtualDomainsMapping instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const BotPasswordsDatabase = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of user rights settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Security | |
| /** @name Security */ | |
| /** | |
| * This should always be customised in LocalSettings.php | |
| */ | |
| public const SecretKey = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * RSA private key for issuing JWTs, as a PEM string. | |
| * Experimental, will probably be replaced by something more flexible. | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| * @see RsaJwtCodec | |
| */ | |
| public const JwtPrivateKey = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * RSA private key for verifying JWTs, as a PEM string. | |
| * Experimental, will probably be replaced by something more flexible. | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| * @see RsaJwtCodec | |
| */ | |
| public const JwtPublicKey = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow user Javascript page? | |
| * This enables a lot of neat customizations, but may | |
| * increase security risk to users and server load. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowUserJs = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow user Cascading Style Sheets (CSS)? | |
| * This enables a lot of neat customizations, but may | |
| * increase security risk to users and server load. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowUserCss = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow style-related user-preferences? | |
| * | |
| * This controls whether the `editfont` and `underline` preferences | |
| * are available to users. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowUserCssPrefs = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use the site's Javascript page? | |
| */ | |
| public const UseSiteJs = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use the site's Cascading Style Sheets (CSS)? | |
| */ | |
| public const UseSiteCss = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Break out of framesets. This can be used to prevent clickjacking attacks, | |
| * or to prevent external sites from framing your site with ads. | |
| */ | |
| public const BreakFrames = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The X-Frame-Options header to send on pages sensitive to clickjacking | |
| * attacks, such as edit pages. This prevents those pages from being displayed | |
| * in a frame or iframe. The options are: | |
| * | |
| * - 'DENY': Do not allow framing. This is recommended for most wikis. | |
| * | |
| * - 'SAMEORIGIN': Allow framing by pages on the same domain. This can be used | |
| * to allow framing within a trusted domain. This is insecure if there | |
| * is a page on the same domain which allows framing of arbitrary URLs. | |
| * | |
| * - false: Allow all framing. This opens up the wiki to XSS attacks and thus | |
| * full compromise of local user accounts. Private wikis behind a | |
| * corporate firewall are especially vulnerable. This is not | |
| * recommended. | |
| * | |
| * For extra safety, set $wgBreakFrames = true, to prevent framing on all pages, | |
| * not just edit pages. | |
| */ | |
| public const EditPageFrameOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => 'DENY', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disallow framing of API pages directly, by setting the X-Frame-Options | |
| * header. Since the API returns CSRF tokens, allowing the results to be | |
| * framed can compromise your user's account security. | |
| * | |
| * Options are: | |
| * - 'DENY': Do not allow framing. This is recommended for most wikis. | |
| * - 'SAMEORIGIN': Allow framing by pages on the same domain. | |
| * - false: Allow all framing. | |
| * Note: $wgBreakFrames will override this for human formatted API output. | |
| */ | |
| public const ApiFrameOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => 'DENY', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Controls Content-Security-Policy header | |
| * | |
| * @warning May cause slowness on Windows due to slow random number generator. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| * @see https://www.w3.org/TR/CSP2/ | |
| */ | |
| public const CSPHeader = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|object', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Controls Content-Security-Policy-Report-Only header | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| */ | |
| public const CSPReportOnlyHeader = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|object', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of urls which appear often to be triggering CSP reports | |
| * but do not appear to be caused by actual content, but by client | |
| * software inserting scripts (i.e. Ad-Ware). | |
| * | |
| * List based on results from Wikimedia logs. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.28 | |
| */ | |
| public const CSPFalsePositiveUrls = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'https://3hub.co' => true, | |
| 'https://morepro.info' => true, | |
| 'https://p.ato.mx' => true, | |
| 'https://s.ato.mx' => true, | |
| 'https://adserver.adtech.de' => true, | |
| 'https://ums.adtechus.com' => true, | |
| 'https://cas.criteo.com' => true, | |
| 'https://cat.nl.eu.criteo.com' => true, | |
| 'https://atpixel.alephd.com' => true, | |
| 'https://rtb.metrigo.com' => true, | |
| 'https://d5p.de17a.com' => true, | |
| 'https://ad.lkqd.net/vpaid/vpaid.js' => true, | |
| 'https://ad.lkqd.net/vpaid/vpaid.js?fusion=1.0' => true, | |
| 'https://t.lkqd.net/t' => true, | |
| 'chrome-extension' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow anonymous cross origin requests to the REST API. | |
| * | |
| * This should be disabled for intranet sites (sites behind a firewall). | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowCrossOrigin = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allows authenticated cross-origin requests to the REST API with session cookies. | |
| * | |
| * With this option enabled, any origin specified in $wgCrossSiteAJAXdomains may send session | |
| * cookies for authorization in the REST API. | |
| * | |
| * There is a performance impact by enabling this option. Therefore, it should be left disabled | |
| * for most wikis and clients should instead use OAuth to make cross-origin authenticated | |
| * requests. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Web/HTTP/Headers/Access-Control-Allow-Credentials | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const RestAllowCrossOriginCookieAuth = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Secret for session storage. | |
| * | |
| * This should be set in LocalSettings.php, otherwise $wgSecretKey will | |
| * be used. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionSecret = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable the deprecated xslt option in the Action API. | |
| * | |
| * This is unsafe and allows users with the editinterface right to perform XSS. | |
| * | |
| * @see https://phabricator.wikimedia.org/T401995 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableUnsafeXsltOption = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of security | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Cookie settings | |
| /** @name Cookie settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Default cookie lifetime, in seconds. Setting to 0 makes all cookies session-only. | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieExpiration = [ | |
| 'default' => 30 * 86400, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default login cookie lifetime, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * If $wgExtendLoginCookieExpiration is set to null, we use $wgCookieExpiration to | |
| * calculate the cookie lifetime instead. As with $wgCookieExpiration, 0 will make | |
| * login cookies session-only. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtendedLoginCookieExpiration = [ | |
| 'default' => 180 * 86400, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * JWT session cookie expiration, in seconds. Used both for cookie expiry and for | |
| * the expiry field inside the JWT object. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| * @see self::UseSessionCookieJwt | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionCookieJwtExpiration = [ | |
| 'default' => 4 * 3600, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to set an explicit domain on the login cookies eg, "justthis.domain.org" | |
| * or ".any.subdomain.net" | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieDomain = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this variable if you want to restrict cookies to a certain path within | |
| * the domain specified by $wgCookieDomain. | |
| */ | |
| public const CookiePath = [ | |
| 'default' => '/', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether the "secure" flag should be set on the cookie. This can be: | |
| * - true: Set secure flag | |
| * - false: Don't set secure flag | |
| * - "detect": Set the secure flag if $wgServer is set to an HTTPS URL, | |
| * or if $wgForceHTTPS is true. | |
| * | |
| * If $wgForceHTTPS is true, session cookies will be secure regardless of this | |
| * setting. However, other cookies will still be affected. | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieSecure = [ | |
| 'default' => 'detect', | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'ForceHTTPS' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultCookieSecure( bool $forceHTTPS ): bool { | |
| return $forceHTTPS || ( WebRequest::detectProtocol() === 'https' ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Cookies generated by MediaWiki have names starting with this prefix. Set it | |
| * to a string to use a custom prefix. Setting it to false causes the database | |
| * name to be used as a prefix. | |
| */ | |
| public const CookiePrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ | |
| 'use' => [ 'SharedDB', 'SharedPrefix', 'SharedTables', 'DBname', 'DBprefix' ] | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| public static function getDefaultCookiePrefix( | |
| ?string $sharedDB, ?string $sharedPrefix, array $sharedTables, string $dbName, string $dbPrefix | |
| ): string { | |
| if ( $sharedDB && in_array( 'user', $sharedTables ) ) { | |
| return $sharedDB . ( $sharedPrefix ? "_$sharedPrefix" : '' ); | |
| } | |
| return $dbName . ( $dbPrefix ? "_$dbPrefix" : '' ); | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * Set authentication cookies to HttpOnly to prevent access by JavaScript, | |
| * in browsers that support this feature. This can mitigates some classes of | |
| * XSS attack. | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieHttpOnly = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The SameSite cookie attribute used for login cookies. This can be "Lax", | |
| * "Strict", "None" or empty/null to omit the attribute. | |
| * | |
| * This only applies to login cookies, since the correct value for other | |
| * cookies depends on what kind of cookie it is. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieSameSite = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A list of cookies that vary the cache (for use by extensions) | |
| */ | |
| public const CacheVaryCookies = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Override to customise the session name | |
| */ | |
| public const SessionName = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to set a cookie when a user is autoblocked. Doing so means that a blocked user, even | |
| * after logging out and moving to a new IP address, will still be blocked. This cookie will | |
| * contain an authentication code if $wgSecretKey is set, or otherwise will just be the block | |
| * ID (in which case there is a possibility of an attacker discovering the names of revdeleted | |
| * users, so it is best to use this in conjunction with $wgSecretKey being set). | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieSetOnAutoblock = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to set a cookie when a logged-out user is blocked. Doing so means that a blocked | |
| * user, even after moving to a new IP address, will still be blocked. This cookie will contain | |
| * an authentication code if $wgSecretKey is set, or otherwise will just be the block ID (in | |
| * which case there is a possibility of an attacker discovering the names of revdeleted users, | |
| * so it is best to use this in conjunction with $wgSecretKey being set). | |
| */ | |
| public const CookieSetOnIpBlock = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of cookie settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Profiling, testing and debugging | |
| /** @name Profiling, testing and debugging */ | |
| // See $wgProfiler for how to enable profiling. | |
| /** | |
| * Enable verbose debug logging for all channels and log levels. | |
| * | |
| * See https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/How_to_debug | |
| * | |
| * For static requests, this enables all channels and warning-level and | |
| * above only. Use $wgDebugRawPage to make those verbose as well. | |
| * | |
| * The debug log file should be not be web-accessible if it is used in | |
| * a production environment, as may contain private data. | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugLogFile = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Prefix for debug log lines | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugLogPrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, instead of redirecting, show a page with a link to the redirect | |
| * destination. This allows for the inspection of PHP error messages, and easy | |
| * resubmission of form data. For developer use only. | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugRedirects = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, debug logging is also enabled for load.php and action=raw requests. | |
| * | |
| * By default, $wgDebugLogFile enables all channels and warning-level and | |
| * above for static requests. | |
| * | |
| * This ensures that the debug log is likely a chronological record of | |
| * of specific web request you are debugging, instead of overlapping with | |
| * messages from static requests, which would make it unclear which message | |
| * originated from what request. | |
| * | |
| * Also, during development this can make browsing and JavaScript testing | |
| * considerably slower (T85805). | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugRawPage = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Send debug data to an HTML comment in the output. | |
| * | |
| * This may occasionally be useful when supporting a non-technical end-user. | |
| * It's more secure than exposing the debug log file to the web, since the | |
| * output only contains private data for the current user. But it's not ideal | |
| * for development use since data is lost on fatal errors and redirects. | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugComments = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Write SQL queries to the debug log. | |
| * | |
| * This setting is only used $wgLBFactoryConf['class'] is set to | |
| * '\Wikimedia\Rdbms\LBFactorySimple'; otherwise the DBO_DEBUG flag must be set in | |
| * the 'flags' option of the database connection to achieve the same functionality. | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugDumpSql = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Performance expectations for DB usage | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const TrxProfilerLimits = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| // HTTP GET/HEAD requests. | |
| // Primary queries should not happen on GET requests | |
| 'GET' => [ | |
| 'masterConns' => 0, | |
| 'writes' => 0, | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 10000 | |
| ], | |
| // HTTP POST requests. | |
| // Primary reads and writes will happen for a subset of these. | |
| 'POST' => [ | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'writeQueryTime' => 1, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 100_000, | |
| 'maxAffected' => 1000 | |
| ], | |
| 'POST-nonwrite' => [ | |
| 'writes' => 0, | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 10000 | |
| ], | |
| // Deferred updates that run after HTTP response is sent for GET requests | |
| 'PostSend-GET' => [ | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'writeQueryTime' => 1, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 10000, | |
| 'maxAffected' => 1000, | |
| // Log primary queries under the post-send entry point as they are discouraged | |
| 'masterConns' => 0, | |
| 'writes' => 0, | |
| ], | |
| // Deferred updates that run after HTTP response is sent for POST requests | |
| 'PostSend-POST' => [ | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'writeQueryTime' => 1, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 100_000, | |
| 'maxAffected' => 1000 | |
| ], | |
| // Background job runner | |
| 'JobRunner' => [ | |
| 'readQueryTime' => 30, | |
| 'writeQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'readQueryRows' => 100_000, | |
| 'maxAffected' => 500 // ballpark of $wgUpdateRowsPerQuery | |
| ], | |
| // Command-line scripts | |
| 'Maintenance' => [ | |
| 'writeQueryTime' => 5, | |
| 'maxAffected' => 1000 | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map of string log group names to log destinations. | |
| * | |
| * If set, wfDebugLog() output for that group will go to that file instead | |
| * of the regular $wgDebugLogFile. Useful for enabling selective logging | |
| * in production. | |
| * | |
| * Log destinations may be one of the following: | |
| * - false to completely remove from the output, including from $wgDebugLogFile. | |
| * - string values specifying a filename or URI. | |
| * - associative array with keys: | |
| * - 'destination' desired filename or URI. | |
| * - 'sample' an integer value, specifying a sampling factor (optional) | |
| * - 'level' A \Psr\Log\LogLevel constant, indicating the minimum level | |
| * to log (optional, since 1.25) | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDebugLogGroups['redis'] = '/var/log/mediawiki/redis.log'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Advanced example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgDebugLogGroups['memcached'] = [ | |
| * 'destination' => '/var/log/mediawiki/memcached.log', | |
| * 'sample' => 1000, // log 1 message out of every 1,000. | |
| * 'level' => \Psr\Log\LogLevel::WARNING | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugLogGroups = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Default service provider for creating Psr\Log\LoggerInterface instances. | |
| * | |
| * The value should be an array suitable for use with | |
| * ObjectFactory::getObjectFromSpec(). The created object is expected to | |
| * implement the MediaWiki\Logger\Spi interface. See ObjectFactory for additional | |
| * details. | |
| * | |
| * Alternately the MediaWiki\Logger\LoggerFactory::registerProvider method can | |
| * be called to inject an MediaWiki\Logger\Spi instance into the LoggerFactory | |
| * and bypass the use of this configuration variable entirely. | |
| * | |
| * **To completely disable logging:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgMWLoggerDefaultSpi = [ 'class' => \MediaWiki\Logger\NullSpi::class ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| * @see \MwLogger | |
| */ | |
| public const MWLoggerDefaultSpi = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'class' => 'MediaWiki\\Logger\\LegacySpi', ], | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'replace', | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Display debug data at the bottom of the main content area. | |
| * | |
| * Useful for developers and technical users trying to working on a closed wiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowDebug = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show the contents of $wgHooks in Special:Version | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialVersionShowHooks = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show exception message and stack trace when printing details about uncaught exceptions | |
| * in web response output. | |
| * | |
| * This may reveal private information in error messages or function parameters. | |
| * If set to false, only the exception type or class name will be exposed. | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowExceptionDetails = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, send the exception backtrace to the error log | |
| */ | |
| public const LogExceptionBacktrace = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If true, the MediaWiki error handler passes errors/warnings to the default error handler | |
| * after logging them. | |
| */ | |
| public const PropagateErrors = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expose backend server host names through the API and various HTML comments | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowHostnames = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Override server hostname detection with a hardcoded value. | |
| * | |
| * Should be a string, default false. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const OverrideHostname = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set to true MediaWiki will throw notices for some possible error | |
| * conditions and for deprecated functions. | |
| */ | |
| public const DevelopmentWarnings = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Release limitation to wfDeprecated warnings, if set to a release number | |
| * development warnings will not be generated for deprecations added in releases | |
| * after the limit. | |
| */ | |
| public const DeprecationReleaseLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Profiler configuration. | |
| * | |
| * To use a profiler, set $wgProfiler in LocalSettings.php. | |
| * | |
| * Options: | |
| * | |
| * - 'class' (`string`): The Profiler subclass to use. | |
| * Default: ProfilerStub. | |
| * - 'sampling' (`integer`): Only enable the profiler on one in this many requests. | |
| * For requests that are not in the sampling, | |
| * the 'class' option will be replaced with ProfilerStub. | |
| * Default: `1`. | |
| * - 'threshold' (`float`): Only process the recorded data if the total elapsed | |
| * time for a request is more than this number of seconds. | |
| * Default: `0.0`. | |
| * - 'output' (`string|string[]`): ProfilerOutput subclass or subclasess to use. | |
| * Default: `[]`. | |
| * | |
| * The options array is passed in its entirety to the specified | |
| * Profiler `class`. Check individual Profiler subclasses for additional | |
| * options that may be available. | |
| * | |
| * Profiler subclasses available in MediaWiki core: | |
| * | |
| * - ProfilerXhprof: Based on XHProf or Tideways-XHProf. | |
| * - ProfilerExcimer: Based on Excimer. | |
| * - ProfilerSectionOnly | |
| * | |
| * Profiler output classes available in MediaWiki: | |
| * | |
| * - ProfilerOutputText: outputs profiling data in the web page body as | |
| * a comment. You can make the profiling data in HTML render visibly | |
| * instead by setting the 'visible' configuration flag. | |
| * | |
| * - ProfilerOutputStats: outputs profiling data in a format as configured | |
| * by $wgStatsFormat. It expects that $wgStatsTarget is set. | |
| * | |
| * - ProfilerOutputDump: outputs dump files that are compatible | |
| * with the XHProf gui. It expects that `$wgProfiler['outputDir']` | |
| * is set as well. | |
| * | |
| * Examples: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgProfiler = [ | |
| * 'class' => ProfilerXhprof::class, | |
| * 'output' => ProfilerOutputText::class, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgProfiler = [ | |
| * 'class' => ProfilerXhprof::class, | |
| * 'output' => [ ProfilerOutputText::class ], | |
| * 'sampling' => 50, // one in every 50 requests | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * For performance, the profiler is always disabled for CLI scripts as they | |
| * could be long running and the data would accumulate. Use the `--profiler` | |
| * parameter of maintenance scripts to override this. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.17.0 | |
| */ | |
| public const Profiler = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'replace', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Destination of statsd metrics. | |
| * | |
| * A host or host:port of a statsd server. Port defaults to 8125. | |
| * | |
| * If not set, statsd metrics will not be collected. | |
| * | |
| * @see MediaWiki::emitBufferedStats() | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const StatsdServer = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Prefix for metric names sent to $wgStatsdServer. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\MediaWikiServices::getInstance()->getStatsdDataFactory | |
| * @see \Wikimedia\Stats\BufferingStatsdDataFactory | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const StatsdMetricPrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => 'MediaWiki', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Stats output target URI e.g. udp://127.0.0.1:8125 | |
| * | |
| * If null, metrics will not be sent. | |
| * Note: this only affects metrics instantiated by the StatsFactory service | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const StatsTarget = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Stats output format | |
| * | |
| * If null, metrics will not be rendered nor sent. | |
| * Note: this only affects metrics instantiated by the StatsFactory service | |
| * | |
| * @see \Wikimedia\Stats\OutputFormats::SUPPORTED_FORMATS | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const StatsFormat = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Stats service name prefix | |
| * | |
| * Required. Must not be zero-length. | |
| * Defaults to: 'mediawiki' | |
| * Note: this only affects metrics instantiated by the StatsFactory service | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const StatsPrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => 'mediawiki', | |
| 'type' => 'string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for OpenTelemetry instrumentation, or `null` to disable it. | |
| * Possible keys: | |
| * - `samplingProbability`: probability in % of sampling a trace for which no sampling decision has been | |
| * taken yet. Must be between 0 and 100. | |
| * - `serviceName`: name of the service being instrumented. | |
| * - `endpoint`: URL of the OpenTelemetry collector to send trace data to. | |
| * This has to be an endpoint accepting OTLP data over HTTP (not gRPC). | |
| * | |
| * An example config to send data to a local OpenTelemetry or Jaeger collector instance: | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgOpenTelemetryConfig = [ | |
| * 'samplingProbability' => 0.1, | |
| * 'serviceName' => 'mediawiki-local', | |
| * 'endpoint' => 'http://127.0.0.1:4318/v1/traces', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * @since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const OpenTelemetryConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => 'map|null' | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * InfoAction retrieves a list of transclusion links (both to and from). | |
| * | |
| * This number puts a limit on that query in the case of highly transcluded | |
| * templates. | |
| */ | |
| public const PageInfoTransclusionLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 50, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow running of QUnit tests via [[Special:JavaScriptTest]]. | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableJavaScriptTest = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Overwrite the caching key prefix with custom value. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.19 | |
| */ | |
| public const CachePrefix = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Display the new debugging toolbar. This also enables profiling on database | |
| * queries and other useful output. | |
| * | |
| * Will be ignored if $wgUseFileCache or $wgUseCdn is enabled. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.19 | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugToolbar = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of profiling, testing and debugging | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Search | |
| /** @name Search */ | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true to disable the full text search feature. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableTextSearch = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set to true to have nicer highlighted text in search results, | |
| * by default off due to execution overhead | |
| */ | |
| public const AdvancedSearchHighlighting = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Regexp to match word boundaries, defaults for non-CJK languages | |
| * should be empty for CJK since the words are not separate | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchHighlightBoundaries = [ | |
| 'default' => '[\\p{Z}\\p{P}\\p{C}]', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Templates for OpenSearch suggestions, defaults to API action=opensearch | |
| * | |
| * Sites with heavy load would typically have these point to a custom | |
| * PHP wrapper to avoid firing up mediawiki for every keystroke | |
| * | |
| * Placeholders: {searchTerms} | |
| */ | |
| public const OpenSearchTemplates = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'application/x-suggestions+json' => false, | |
| 'application/x-suggestions+xml' => false, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This was previously a used to force empty responses from ApiOpenSearch | |
| * with the 'suggest' parameter set. | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.35 No longer used | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableOpenSearchSuggest = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'obsolete' => 'Since 1.35, no longer used', | |
| 'description' => 'Has been emitting warnings since 1.39 (LTS). ' . | |
| 'Can be removed completely in 1.44, assuming 1.43 is an LTS release.' | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Integer defining default number of entries to show on | |
| * OpenSearch call. | |
| */ | |
| public const OpenSearchDefaultLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 10, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Minimum length of extract in <Description>. Actual extracts will last until the end of | |
| * sentence. | |
| */ | |
| public const OpenSearchDescriptionLength = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expiry time for search suggestion responses | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchSuggestCacheExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 1200, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If you've disabled search semi-permanently, this also disables updates to the | |
| * table. If you ever re-enable, be sure to rebuild the search table. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableSearchUpdate = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of namespaces which are searched by default. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgNamespacesToBeSearchedDefault[NS_MAIN] = true; | |
| * $wgNamespacesToBeSearchedDefault[NS_PROJECT] = true; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespacesToBeSearchedDefault = [ | |
| 'default' => [ NS_MAIN => true, ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable the internal MySQL-based search, to allow it to be | |
| * implemented by an extension instead. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableInternalSearch = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to a URL to forward search requests to some external location. | |
| * | |
| * If the URL includes '$1', this will be replaced with the URL-encoded | |
| * search term. Before using this, $wgDisableTextSearch must be set to true. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * To forward to Google you'd have something like: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgSearchForwardUrl = | |
| * 'https://www.google.com/search?q=$1' . | |
| * '&domains=https://example.com' . | |
| * '&sitesearch=https://example.com' . | |
| * '&ie=utf-8&oe=utf-8'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchForwardUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of namespaces to generate a Google sitemap for when the | |
| * maintenance/generateSitemap.php script is run. If this is false, the API | |
| * will consult NamespaceRobotPolicies, whereas the maintenance script will | |
| * produce a sitemap for all namespaces. | |
| */ | |
| public const SitemapNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @deprecated since 1.45 and ignored | |
| */ | |
| public const SitemapNamespacesPriorities = [ | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.45 and ignored', | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'false|map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for the sitemaps REST API endpoint /rest.php/site/v1/sitemap/0 | |
| * | |
| * To use this API, set `$wgSitemapApiConfig['enabled'] = true` and then add | |
| * to robots.txt something like: | |
| * | |
| * Sitemap: http://www.example.org/w/rest.php/site/v1/sitemap/0 | |
| * | |
| * Search engines like Google will then use the sitemap to efficiently | |
| * discover pages on your site. | |
| * | |
| * If you have more than 500M pages (sitemapsPerIndex × pagesPerSitemap) | |
| * you can list multiple sitemaps in robots.txt, incrementing the number in | |
| * the index URL. | |
| * | |
| * An associative array with the following keys: | |
| * - enabled: Whether to deliver sitemaps. | |
| * Default: false. | |
| * - sitemapsPerIndex: The maximum number of sitemap files to link to from | |
| * each index file. This must be 50,000 or less to comply with the | |
| * protocol. | |
| * Default: 50,000. | |
| * - pagesPerSitemap: The maximum number of URLs to link to from each | |
| * sitemap file. This must be 50,000 or less to comply with the protocol. | |
| * It might take a few seconds to render a sitemap with 50,000 URLs. | |
| * Default: 10,000. | |
| * - expiry: The cache expiry time in seconds. | |
| * Default: 3600 (1 hour). | |
| * | |
| * @see https://www.sitemaps.org/protocol.html | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Rest\Handler\SitemapHandlerBase | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const SitemapApiConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'enabled' => [ 'type' => 'bool' ], | |
| 'sitemapsPerIndex' => [ 'type' => 'int' ], | |
| 'pagesPerSitemap' => [ 'type' => 'int' ], | |
| 'expiry' => [ 'type' => 'int' ], | |
| ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Options for Special:Search completion widget form created by SearchFormWidget class. | |
| * | |
| * Settings that can be used: | |
| * - showDescriptions: true/false - whether to show opensearch description results | |
| * - performSearchOnClick: true/false - whether to perform search on click | |
| * See also TitleWidget.js UI widget. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialSearchFormOptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set true to allow logged-in users to set a preference whether or not matches in | |
| * search results should force redirection to that page. If false, the preference is | |
| * not exposed and cannot be altered from site default. To change your site's default | |
| * preference, set via $wgDefaultUserOptions['search-match-redirect']. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchMatchRedirectPreference = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Controls whether zero-result search queries with suggestions should display results for | |
| * these suggestions. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const SearchRunSuggestedQuery = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of search settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Edit user interface | |
| /** @name Edit user interface */ | |
| /** | |
| * Path to the GNU diff3 utility. If the file doesn't exist, edit conflicts will | |
| * fall back to the old behavior (no merging). | |
| */ | |
| public const Diff3 = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/diff3', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Path to the GNU diff utility. | |
| */ | |
| public const Diff = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/diff', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Which namespaces have special treatment where they should be preview-on-open | |
| * Internally only Category: pages apply, but using this extensions (e.g. Semantic MediaWiki) | |
| * can specify namespaces of pages they have special treatment for | |
| */ | |
| public const PreviewOnOpenNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| NS_CATEGORY => true | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable the UniversalEditButton for browsers that support it | |
| * (currently only Firefox with an extension) | |
| * See http://universaleditbutton.org for more background information | |
| */ | |
| public const UniversalEditButton = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If user doesn't specify any edit summary when making a an edit, MediaWiki | |
| * will try to automatically create one. This feature can be disabled by set- | |
| * ting this variable false. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseAutomaticEditSummaries = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end edit UI | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Maintenance | |
| /** @name Maintenance */ | |
| // See also $wgSiteNotice | |
| /** | |
| * For colorized maintenance script output, is your terminal background dark ? | |
| */ | |
| public const CommandLineDarkBg = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to a string to put the wiki into read-only mode. The text will be | |
| * used as an explanation to users. | |
| * | |
| * This prevents most write operations via the web interface. Cache updates may | |
| * still be possible. To prevent database writes completely, use the read_only | |
| * option in MySQL. | |
| */ | |
| public const ReadOnly = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true to put the wiki watchlists into read-only mode. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.31 | |
| */ | |
| public const ReadOnlyWatchedItemStore = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If this lock file exists (size > 0), the wiki will be forced into read-only mode. | |
| * | |
| * Its contents will be shown to users as part of the read-only warning | |
| * message. | |
| * | |
| * Will default to "{$wgUploadDirectory}/lock_yBgMBwiR" in Setup.php | |
| */ | |
| public const ReadOnlyFile = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'dynamicDefault' => [ 'use' => [ 'UploadDirectory' ] ] | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * @param mixed $uploadDirectory Value of UploadDirectory | |
| * @return string | |
| */ | |
| public static function getDefaultReadOnlyFile( $uploadDirectory ): string { | |
| return "$uploadDirectory/lock_yBgMBwiR"; | |
| } | |
| /** | |
| * When you run the web-based upgrade utility, it will tell you what to set | |
| * this to in order to authorize the upgrade process. It will subsequently be | |
| * used as a password, to authorize further upgrades. | |
| * | |
| * For security, do not set this to a guessable string. Use the value supplied | |
| * by the install/upgrade process. To cause the upgrader to generate a new key, | |
| * delete the old key from LocalSettings.php. | |
| */ | |
| public const UpgradeKey = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Fully specified path to git binary | |
| */ | |
| public const GitBin = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/git', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map GIT repository URLs to viewer URLs to provide links in Special:Version | |
| * | |
| * Key is a pattern passed to preg_match() and preg_replace(), | |
| * without the delimiters (which are #) and must match the whole URL. | |
| * The value is the replacement for the key (it can contain $1, etc.) | |
| * %h will be replaced by the short SHA-1 (7 first chars) and %H by the | |
| * full SHA-1 of the HEAD revision. | |
| * %r will be replaced with a URL-encoded version of $1. | |
| * %R will be replaced with $1 and no URL-encoding | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.20 | |
| */ | |
| public const GitRepositoryViewers = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'https://(?:[a-z0-9_]+@)?gerrit.wikimedia.org/r/(?:p/)?(.*)' => 'https://gerrit.wikimedia.org/g/%R/+/%H', | |
| 'ssh://(?:[a-z0-9_]+@)?gerrit.wikimedia.org:29418/(.*)' => 'https://gerrit.wikimedia.org/g/%R/+/%H', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Initial content to create when installing a wiki. An array of page info | |
| * arrays. Each must contain at least one of: | |
| * - title: The title to create (string) | |
| * - titlemsg: The name of a message to read the title from | |
| * | |
| * And one of: | |
| * - text: The text to write to the page (string) | |
| * - textmsg: The name of a message to read the page contents from | |
| * | |
| * The text may contain | |
| * - {{InstallerOption:<name>}}: This will be replaced with the named option value | |
| * - {{InstallerConfig:<name>}}: This will be replaced with the named config value | |
| * | |
| * @see \InstallPreConfigured | |
| * @since 1.44 | |
| */ | |
| public const InstallerInitialPages = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| [ | |
| 'titlemsg' => 'mainpage', | |
| 'text' => "{{subst:int:mainpagetext}}\n\n{{subst:int:mainpagedocfooter}}", | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list' | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End of maintenance | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Recent changes, new pages, watchlist and history | |
| /** @name Recent changes, new pages, watchlist and history */ | |
| /** | |
| * Recentchanges items are periodically purged; entries older than this many | |
| * seconds will go. | |
| * | |
| * Default: 90 days = about three months | |
| */ | |
| public const RCMaxAge = [ | |
| 'default' => 90 * 24 * 3600, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Page watchers inactive for more than this many seconds are considered inactive. | |
| * | |
| * Used mainly by action=info. Default: 180 days = about six months. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const WatchersMaxAge = [ | |
| 'default' => 180 * 24 * 3600, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If active watchers (per above) are this number or less, do not disclose it. | |
| * | |
| * Left to 1, prevents unprivileged users from knowing for sure that there are 0. | |
| * Set to -1 if you want to always complement watchers count with this info. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.26 | |
| */ | |
| public const UnwatchedPageSecret = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Filter $wgRCLinkDays by $wgRCMaxAge to avoid showing links for numbers | |
| * higher than what will be stored. Note that this is disabled by default | |
| * because we sometimes do have RC data which is beyond the limit for some | |
| * reason, and some users may use the high numbers to display that data which | |
| * is still there. | |
| */ | |
| public const RCFilterByAge = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of Limits options to list in the Special:Recentchanges and | |
| * Special:Recentchangeslinked pages. | |
| */ | |
| public const RCLinkLimits = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 50, 100, 250, 500 ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of Days options to list in the Special:Recentchanges and | |
| * Special:Recentchangeslinked pages. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\SpecialPage\ChangesListSpecialPage::getLinkDays | |
| */ | |
| public const RCLinkDays = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 1, 3, 7, 14, 30 ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Configuration for feeds to which notifications about recent changes will be sent. | |
| * | |
| * The following feed classes are available by default: | |
| * - 'UDPRCFeedEngine' - sends recent changes over UDP to the specified server. | |
| * - 'RedisPubSubFeedEngine' - send recent changes to Redis. | |
| * | |
| * Only 'class' or 'uri' is required. If 'uri' is set instead of 'class', then | |
| * RecentChange::getEngine() is used to determine the class. All options are | |
| * passed to the constructor. | |
| * | |
| * Common options: | |
| * - 'class' -- The class to use for this feed (must implement RCFeed). | |
| * - 'omit_bots' -- Exclude bot edits from the feed. (default: false) | |
| * - 'omit_anon' -- Exclude anonymous edits from the feed. (default: false) | |
| * - 'omit_user' -- Exclude edits by registered users from the feed. (default: false) | |
| * - 'omit_minor' -- Exclude minor edits from the feed. (default: false) | |
| * - 'omit_patrolled' -- Exclude patrolled edits from the feed. (default: false) | |
| * | |
| * FormattedRCFeed-specific options: | |
| * - 'uri' -- [required] The address to which the messages are sent. | |
| * The uri scheme of this string will be looked up in $wgRCEngines | |
| * to determine which FormattedRCFeed class to use. | |
| * - 'formatter' -- [required] The class (implementing RCFeedFormatter) which will | |
| * produce the text to send. This can also be an object of the class. | |
| * Formatters available by default: JSONRCFeedFormatter, XMLRCFeedFormatter, | |
| * IRCColourfulRCFeedFormatter. | |
| * | |
| * IRCColourfulRCFeedFormatter-specific options: | |
| * - 'add_interwiki_prefix' -- whether the titles should be prefixed with | |
| * the first entry in the $wgLocalInterwikis array | |
| * | |
| * JSONRCFeedFormatter-specific options: | |
| * - 'channel' -- if set, the 'channel' parameter is also set in JSON values. | |
| * | |
| * **Examples:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRCFeeds['example'] = [ | |
| * 'uri' => 'udp://localhost:1336', | |
| * 'formatter' => 'JSONRCFeedFormatter', | |
| * 'add_interwiki_prefix' => false, | |
| * 'omit_bots' => true, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRCFeeds['example'] = [ | |
| * 'uri' => 'udp://localhost:1338', | |
| * 'formatter' => 'IRCColourfulRCFeedFormatter', | |
| * 'add_interwiki_prefix' => false, | |
| * 'omit_bots' => true, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRCFeeds['example'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => ExampleRCFeed::class, | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const RCFeeds = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Used by RecentChange::getEngine to find the correct engine for a given URI scheme. | |
| * | |
| * Keys are scheme names, values are names of FormattedRCFeed sub classes. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const RCEngines = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'redis' => RedisPubSubFeedEngine::class, | |
| 'udp' => UDPRCFeedEngine::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Treat category membership changes as a RecentChange. | |
| * | |
| * Changes are mentioned in RC for page actions as follows: | |
| * - creation: pages created with categories are mentioned | |
| * - edit: category additions/removals to existing pages are mentioned | |
| * - move: nothing is mentioned (unless templates used depend on the title) | |
| * - deletion: nothing is mentioned | |
| * - undeletion: nothing is mentioned | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const RCWatchCategoryMembership = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use RC Patrolling to check for vandalism (from recent changes and watchlists) | |
| * New pages and new files are included. | |
| * | |
| * @note If you disable all patrolling features, you probably also want to | |
| * remove 'patrol' from $wgFilterLogTypes so a show/hide link isn't shown on | |
| * Special:Log. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseRCPatrol = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Polling rate, in seconds, used by the 'live update' and 'view newest' features | |
| * of the RCFilters app on SpecialRecentChanges and Special:Watchlist. | |
| * | |
| * 0 to disable completely. | |
| */ | |
| public const StructuredChangeFiltersLiveUpdatePollingRate = [ | |
| 'default' => 3, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use new page patrolling to check new pages on Special:Newpages | |
| * | |
| * @note If you disable all patrolling features, you probably also want to | |
| * remove 'patrol' from $wgFilterLogTypes so a show/hide link isn't shown on | |
| * Special:Log. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseNPPatrol = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Use file patrolling to check new files on Special:Newfiles | |
| * | |
| * @note If you disable all patrolling features, you probably also want to | |
| * remove 'patrol' from $wgFilterLogTypes so a show/hide link isn't shown on | |
| * Special:Log. | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseFilePatrol = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Provide syndication feeds (RSS, Atom) for, e.g., Recentchanges, Newpages | |
| */ | |
| public const Feed = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set maximum number of results to return in syndication feeds (RSS, Atom) for | |
| * eg Recentchanges, Newpages. | |
| */ | |
| public const FeedLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 50, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * _Minimum_ timeout for cached Recentchanges feed, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * A cached version will continue to be served out even if changes | |
| * are made, until this many seconds runs out since the last render. | |
| * | |
| * If set to 0, feed caching is disabled. Use this for debugging only; | |
| * feed generation can be pretty slow with diffs. | |
| */ | |
| public const FeedCacheTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When generating Recentchanges RSS/Atom feed, diffs will not be generated for | |
| * pages larger than this size. | |
| */ | |
| public const FeedDiffCutoff = [ | |
| 'default' => 32768, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Override the site's default RSS/ATOM feed for recentchanges that appears on | |
| * every page. Some sites might have a different feed they'd like to promote | |
| * instead of the RC feed (maybe like a "Recent New Articles" or "Breaking news" one). | |
| * | |
| * Should be a format as key (either 'rss' or 'atom') and an URL to the feed | |
| * as value. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * Configure the 'atom' feed to https://example.com/somefeed.xml | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgSiteFeed['atom'] = "https://example.com/somefeed.xml"; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const OverrideSiteFeed = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Available feeds objects. | |
| * | |
| * Should probably only be defined when a page is syndicated ie when | |
| * $wgOut->isSyndicated() is true. | |
| */ | |
| public const FeedClasses = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'rss' => \MediaWiki\Feed\RSSFeed::class, | |
| 'atom' => \MediaWiki\Feed\AtomFeed::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Which feed types should we provide by default? This can include 'rss', | |
| * 'atom', neither, or both. | |
| */ | |
| public const AdvertisedFeedTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'atom', ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show watching users in recent changes, watchlist and page history views | |
| */ | |
| public const RCShowWatchingUsers = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show the amount of changed characters in recent changes | |
| */ | |
| public const RCShowChangedSize = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If the difference between the character counts of the text | |
| * before and after the edit is below that value, the value will be | |
| * highlighted on the RC page. | |
| */ | |
| public const RCChangedSizeThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => 500, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show "Updated (since my last visit)" marker in RC view, watchlist and history | |
| * view for watched pages with new changes | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowUpdatedMarker = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Disable links to talk pages of anonymous users (IPs) in listings on special | |
| * pages like page history, Special:Recentchanges, etc. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableAnonTalk = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow filtering by change tag in recentchanges, history, etc | |
| * Has no effect if no tags are defined. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseTagFilter = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of core tags to enable. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.31 | |
| * @since 1.36 Added 'mw-manual-revert' and 'mw-reverted' | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_CONTENT_MODEL_CHANGE | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_NEW_REDIRECT | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_REMOVED_REDIRECT | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_CHANGED_REDIRECT_TARGET | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_BLANK | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_REPLACE | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_RECREATE | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_ROLLBACK | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_UNDO | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_MANUAL_REVERT | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_REVERTED | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\ChangeTags\ChangeTags::TAG_SERVER_SIDE_UPLOAD | |
| */ | |
| public const SoftwareTags = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'mw-contentmodelchange' => true, | |
| 'mw-new-redirect' => true, | |
| 'mw-removed-redirect' => true, | |
| 'mw-changed-redirect-target' => true, | |
| 'mw-blank' => true, | |
| 'mw-replace' => true, | |
| 'mw-recreated' => true, | |
| 'mw-rollback' => true, | |
| 'mw-undo' => true, | |
| 'mw-manual-revert' => true, | |
| 'mw-reverted' => true, | |
| 'mw-server-side-upload' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'boolean', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set to an integer, pages that are watched by this many users or more | |
| * will not require the unwatchedpages permission to view the number of | |
| * watchers. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const UnwatchedPageThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Flags (letter symbols) shown in recent changes and watchlist to indicate | |
| * certain types of edits. | |
| * | |
| * To register a new one: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgRecentChangesFlags['flag'] => [ | |
| * // message for the letter displayed next to rows on changes lists | |
| * 'letter' => 'letter-msg', | |
| * // message for the tooltip of the letter | |
| * 'title' => 'tooltip-msg', | |
| * // optional (defaults to 'tooltip-msg'), message to use in the legend box | |
| * 'legend' => 'legend-msg', | |
| * // optional (defaults to 'flag'), CSS class to put on changes lists rows | |
| * 'class' => 'css-class', | |
| * // optional (defaults to 'any'), how top-level flag is determined. 'any' | |
| * // will set the top-level flag if any line contains the flag, 'all' will | |
| * // only be set if all lines contain the flag. | |
| * 'grouping' => 'any', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const RecentChangesFlags = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'newpage' => [ | |
| 'letter' => 'newpageletter', | |
| 'title' => 'recentchanges-label-newpage', | |
| 'legend' => 'recentchanges-legend-newpage', | |
| 'grouping' => 'any', | |
| ], | |
| 'minor' => [ | |
| 'letter' => 'minoreditletter', | |
| 'title' => 'recentchanges-label-minor', | |
| 'legend' => 'recentchanges-legend-minor', | |
| 'class' => 'minoredit', | |
| 'grouping' => 'all', | |
| ], | |
| 'bot' => [ | |
| 'letter' => 'boteditletter', | |
| 'title' => 'recentchanges-label-bot', | |
| 'legend' => 'recentchanges-legend-bot', | |
| 'class' => 'botedit', | |
| 'grouping' => 'all', | |
| ], | |
| 'unpatrolled' => [ | |
| 'letter' => 'unpatrolledletter', | |
| 'title' => 'recentchanges-label-unpatrolled', | |
| 'legend' => 'recentchanges-legend-unpatrolled', | |
| 'grouping' => 'any', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable the watchlist expiry feature. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const WatchlistExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Chance of expired watchlist items being purged on any page edit. | |
| * | |
| * Only has effect if $wgWatchlistExpiry is true. | |
| * | |
| * If this is zero, expired watchlist items will not be removed | |
| * and the purgeExpiredWatchlistItems.php maintenance script should be run periodically. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const WatchlistPurgeRate = [ | |
| 'default' => 0.1, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Relative maximum duration for watchlist expiries, as accepted by strtotime(). | |
| * | |
| * This relates to finite watchlist expiries only. Pages can be watched indefinitely | |
| * regardless of what this is set to. | |
| * | |
| * This is used to ensure the watchlist_expiry table doesn't grow to be too big. | |
| * | |
| * Only has effect if $wgWatchlistExpiry is true. | |
| * | |
| * Set to null to allow expiries of any duration. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const WatchlistExpiryMaxDuration = [ | |
| 'default' => '1 year', | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable pagination on Special:EditWatchlist (feature flag) | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const EditWatchlistPaginate = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow Watchlist and RecentChangesLinked queries to be partitioned by | |
| * rc_timestamp. This may help with performance. (T403798) | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableChangesListQueryPartitioning = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'bool', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end RC/watchlist | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Copyright and credits settings | |
| /** @name Copyright and credits settings */ | |
| /** | |
| * Override for copyright metadata. | |
| * | |
| * This is the name of the page containing information about the wiki's copyright status, | |
| * which will be added as a link in the footer if it is specified. It overrides | |
| * $wgRightsUrl if both are specified. | |
| */ | |
| public const RightsPage = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to specify an external URL containing details about the content license used on your | |
| * wiki. | |
| * | |
| * If $wgRightsPage is set then this setting is ignored. | |
| */ | |
| public const RightsUrl = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If either $wgRightsUrl or $wgRightsPage is specified then this variable gives the text for | |
| * the link. Otherwise, it will be treated as raw HTML. | |
| * | |
| * If using $wgRightsUrl then this value must be specified. If using $wgRightsPage then the | |
| * name | |
| * of the page will also be used as the link text if this variable is not set. | |
| */ | |
| public const RightsText = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Override for copyright metadata. | |
| */ | |
| public const RightsIcon = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to true if you want detailed copyright information forms on Upload. | |
| */ | |
| public const UseCopyrightUpload = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to the number of authors that you want to be credited below an | |
| * article text. Set it to zero to hide the attribution block, and a negative | |
| * number (like -1) to show all authors. Note that this will require 2-3 extra | |
| * database hits, which can have a not insignificant impact on performance for | |
| * large wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxCredits = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If there are more than $wgMaxCredits authors, show $wgMaxCredits of them. | |
| * | |
| * Otherwise, link to a separate credits page. | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowCreditsIfMax = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of copyright and credits settings | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Import / Export | |
| /** @name Import / Export */ | |
| /** | |
| * List of interwiki prefixes for wikis we'll accept as sources for | |
| * Special:Import and API action=import. Since complete page history can be | |
| * imported, these should be 'trusted'. | |
| * | |
| * This can either be a regular array, or an associative map specifying | |
| * subprojects on the interwiki map of the target wiki, or a mix of the two, | |
| * e.g. | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgImportSources = [ | |
| * 'wikipedia' => [ 'cs', 'en', 'fr', 'zh' ], | |
| * 'wikispecies', | |
| * 'wikia' => [ 'animanga', 'brickipedia', 'desserts' ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * If you have a very complex import sources setup, you can lazy-load it using | |
| * the ImportSources hook. | |
| * | |
| * If a user has the 'import' permission but not the 'importupload' permission, | |
| * they will only be able to run imports through this transwiki interface. | |
| */ | |
| public const ImportSources = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Optional default target namespace for interwiki imports. | |
| * | |
| * Can use this to create an incoming "transwiki"-style queue. | |
| * Set to numeric key, not the name. | |
| * | |
| * Users may override this in the Special:Import dialog. | |
| */ | |
| public const ImportTargetNamespace = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set to false, disables the full-history option on Special:Export. | |
| * | |
| * This is currently poorly optimized for long edit histories, so is | |
| * disabled on Wikimedia's sites. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportAllowHistory = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If set nonzero, Special:Export requests for history of pages with | |
| * more revisions than this will be rejected. On some big sites things | |
| * could get bogged down by very very long pages. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportMaxHistory = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Return distinct author list (when not returning full history) | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportAllowListContributors = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * If non-zero, Special:Export accepts a "pagelink-depth" parameter | |
| * up to this specified level, which will cause it to include all | |
| * pages linked to from the pages you specify. Since this number | |
| * can become *really really large* and could easily break your wiki, | |
| * it's disabled by default for now. | |
| * | |
| * @warning There's a HARD CODED limit of 5 levels of recursion to prevent a | |
| * crazy-big export from being done by someone setting the depth number too | |
| * high. In other words, last resort safety net. | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportMaxLinkDepth = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow the "export all pages in namespace" option | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportFromNamespaces = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to allow exporting the entire wiki into a single file | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportAllowAll = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of pages returned by the GetPagesFromCategory and | |
| * GetPagesFromNamespace functions. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExportPagelistLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 5000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The schema to use by default when generating XML dumps. This allows sites to control | |
| * explicitly when to make breaking changes to their export and dump format. | |
| */ | |
| public const XmlDumpSchemaVersion = [ | |
| 'default' => XML_DUMP_SCHEMA_VERSION_11, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end of import/export | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Wiki Farm | |
| /** @name Wiki Farm */ | |
| /** | |
| * A directory that contains site-specific configuration files. | |
| * | |
| * Setting this will enable multi-tenant ("wiki farm") mode, causing | |
| * site-specific settings to be loaded based on information from the web request. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const WikiFarmSettingsDirectory = [ | |
| 'default' => null | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The file extension to be used when looking up site-specific settings files in | |
| * $wgWikiFarmSettingsDirectory, such as 'json' or 'yaml'. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const WikiFarmSettingsExtension = [ | |
| 'default' => 'yaml' | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End Wiki Farm | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Extensions | |
| /** @name Extensions */ | |
| /** | |
| * A list of callback functions which are called once MediaWiki is fully | |
| * initialised | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionFunctions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Extension messages files. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping extension name to the filename where messages can be | |
| * found. The file should contain variable assignments. Any of the variables | |
| * present in languages/messages/MessagesEn.php may be defined, but the most common | |
| * ones are $namespaceNames and $namespaceAliases for namespaces, $specialPageAliases | |
| * for special page names and $magicWords for magic words. | |
| * | |
| * Variables defined in extensions will override conflicting variables defined | |
| * in the core. | |
| * | |
| * Before MediaWiki 1.23, this variable was most commonly used to define messages, | |
| * but since the introduction of $wgMessageDirs in that version, that is discouraged; | |
| * instead, store messages in JSON format and use $wgMessagesDirs. For setting other | |
| * variables than $messages, $wgExtensionMessagesFiles should still be used. Use a | |
| * DIFFERENT key, because any entry having a key that also exists in $wgMessagesDirs | |
| * will be ignored. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions using the JSON message format can preserve backward compatibility with | |
| * earlier versions of MediaWiki by using a compatibility shim, such as one generated | |
| * by the generateJsonI18n.php maintenance script, listing it under the SAME key | |
| * as for the $wgMessagesDirs entry. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExtensionMessagesFiles['ConfirmEdit'] = __DIR__.'/ConfirmEdit.i18n.php'; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionMessagesFiles = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Extension messages directories. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping extension name to the path of the directory where message files can | |
| * be found. The message files are expected to be JSON files named for their language code, e.g. | |
| * en.json, de.json, etc. Extensions with messages in multiple places may specify an array of | |
| * message directories. | |
| * | |
| * Message directories in core should be added to LocalisationCache::getMessagesDirs() | |
| * | |
| * **Simple example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgMessagesDirs['Example'] = __DIR__ . '/i18n'; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Complex example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgMessagesDirs['Example'] = [ | |
| * __DIR__ . '/lib/ve/i18n', | |
| * __DIR__ . '/lib/ooui/i18n', | |
| * __DIR__ . '/i18n', | |
| * ] | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const MessagesDirs = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Message directories containing JSON files for localisation of special page aliases. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping extension name to the directory where configurations can be | |
| * found. The directory is expected to contain JSON files corresponding to each language code. | |
| * | |
| * Variables defined in extensions will override conflicting variables defined | |
| * in the core. We recommend using this configuration to set variables that require localisation: | |
| * special page aliases, and in the future namespace aliases and magic words. | |
| * | |
| * **Simple example**: extension.json | |
| * ``` | |
| * "TranslationAliasesDirs": { | |
| * "TranslationNotificationsAlias": "i18n/aliases" | |
| * } | |
| * ``` | |
| * **Complex example**: extension.json | |
| * ``` | |
| * "TranslationAliasesDirs": { | |
| * "TranslationNotificationsAlias": [ "i18n/special-page-aliases", "i18n/magic-words", "i18n/namespaces" ] | |
| * } | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const TranslationAliasesDirs = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array of files with list(s) of extension entry points to be used in | |
| * maintenance/mergeMessageFileList.php | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionEntryPointListFiles = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to include the NewPP limit report as a HTML comment | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableParserLimitReporting = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of valid skin names | |
| * | |
| * The key should be the name in all lower case. | |
| * | |
| * As of 1.35, the value should be a an array in the form of the ObjectFactory specification. | |
| * | |
| * For example for 'foobarskin' where the PHP class is 'MediaWiki\Skins\FooBar\FooBarSkin' set: | |
| * | |
| * **skin.json Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * "ValidSkinNames": { | |
| * "foobarskin": { | |
| * "displayname": "FooBarSkin", | |
| * "class": "MediaWiki\\Skins\\FooBar\\FooBarSkin" | |
| * } | |
| * } | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * Historically, the value was a properly cased name for the skin (and is still currently | |
| * supported). This value will be prefixed with "Skin" to create the class name of the | |
| * skin to load. Use SkinFactory::getInstalledSkins() as an accessor if you wish to have access to the | |
| * full list. | |
| */ | |
| public const ValidSkinNames = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Special page list. This is an associative array mapping the (canonical) names of | |
| * special pages to either a class name or a ObjectFactory spec to be instantiated, or a callback to use for | |
| * creating the special page object. In all cases, the result must be an instance of SpecialPage. | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialPages = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Obsolete switch that controlled legacy case-insensitive classloading. | |
| * | |
| * Case-insensitive classloading was needed for loading data that had | |
| * been serialized by PHP 4 with the class names converted to lowercase. | |
| * It is no longer necessary since 1.31; the lowercase forms in question | |
| * are now listed in autoload.php (T166759). | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const AutoloadAttemptLowercase = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'obsolete' => 'Since 1.40; no longer has any effect.', | |
| 'description' => 'Has been emitting warnings since 1.39 (LTS). ' . | |
| 'Can be removed completely in 1.44, assuming 1.43 is an LTS release.' | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Add information about an installed extension, keyed by its type. | |
| * | |
| * This is for use from LocalSettings.php and legacy PHP-entrypoint | |
| * extensions. In general, extensions should (only) declare this | |
| * information in their extension.json file. | |
| * | |
| * The 'name', 'path' and 'author' keys are required. | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExtensionCredits['other'][] = [ | |
| * 'path' => __FILE__, | |
| * 'name' => 'Example extension', | |
| * 'namemsg' => 'exampleextension-name', | |
| * 'author' => [ | |
| * 'Foo Barstein', | |
| * ], | |
| * 'version' => '0.0.1', | |
| * 'url' => 'https://example.org/example-extension/', | |
| * 'descriptionmsg' => 'exampleextension-desc', | |
| * 'license-name' => 'GPL-2.0-or-later', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * The extensions are listed on Special:Version. This page also looks for a file | |
| * named COPYING or LICENSE (optional .txt extension) and provides a link to | |
| * view said file. When the 'license-name' key is specified, this file is | |
| * interpreted as wikitext. | |
| * | |
| * - $type: One of 'specialpage', 'parserhook', 'variable', 'media', 'antispam', | |
| * 'skin', 'api', or 'other', or any additional types as specified through the | |
| * ExtensionTypes hook as used in SpecialVersion::getExtensionTypes(). | |
| * | |
| * - name: Name of extension as an inline string instead of localizable message. | |
| * Do not omit this even if 'namemsg' is provided, as it is used to override | |
| * the path Special:Version uses to find extension's license info, and is | |
| * required for backwards-compatibility with MediaWiki 1.23 and older. | |
| * | |
| * - namemsg (since MW 1.24): A message key for a message containing the | |
| * extension's name, if the name is localizable. (For example, skin names | |
| * usually are.) | |
| * | |
| * - author: A string or an array of strings. Authors can be linked using | |
| * the regular wikitext link syntax. To have an internationalized version of | |
| * "and others" show, add an element "...". This element can also be linked, | |
| * for instance "[https://example ...]". | |
| * | |
| * - descriptionmsg: A message key or an array with message key and parameters: | |
| * `'descriptionmsg' => 'exampleextension-desc',` | |
| * | |
| * - description: Description of extension as an inline string instead of | |
| * localizable message (omit in favour of 'descriptionmsg'). | |
| * | |
| * - license-name: Short name of the license (used as label for the link), such | |
| * as "GPL-2.0-or-later" or "MIT" (https://spdx.org/licenses/ for a list of identifiers). | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Specials\SpecialVersion::getCredits | |
| */ | |
| public const ExtensionCredits = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Global list of hooks. | |
| * | |
| * The key is one of the events made available by MediaWiki, you can find | |
| * a description for most of them in their respective hook interfaces. For | |
| * overview of the hook system see docs/Hooks.md. The array is used internally | |
| * by HookContainer::run(). | |
| * | |
| * The value can be one of: | |
| * | |
| * - A function name: `$wgHooks['event_name'][] = $function;` | |
| * | |
| * - A function with some data: `$wgHooks['event_name'][] = [ $function, $data ];` | |
| * | |
| * | |
| * - A an object method: `$wgHooks['event_name'][] = [ $object, 'method' ];` | |
| * | |
| * - A closure: | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgHooks['event_name'][] = function ( $hookParam ) { | |
| * // Handler code goes here. | |
| * }; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * @warning You should always append to an event array or you will end up | |
| * deleting a previous registered hook. | |
| * @warning Hook handlers should be registered at file scope. Registering | |
| * handlers after file scope can lead to unexpected results due to caching. | |
| */ | |
| public const Hooks = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_merge_recursive', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of service wiring files to be loaded by the default instance of MediaWikiServices. Each | |
| * file listed here is expected to return an associative array mapping service names to | |
| * instantiator functions. Extensions may add wiring files to define their own services. | |
| * However, this cannot be used to replace existing services - use the MediaWikiServices hook | |
| * for that. | |
| * | |
| * @note the default wiring file will be added automatically by Setup.php | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\MediaWikiServices | |
| * @see \Wikimedia\Services\ServiceContainer::loadWiringFiles() for details on loading | |
| * service instantiator functions. | |
| * @see docs/Injection.md for an overview of dependency | |
| * injection in MediaWiki. | |
| */ | |
| public const ServiceWiringFiles = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maps jobs to their handlers; extensions | |
| * can add to this to provide custom jobs. | |
| * | |
| * Since 1.40, job handlers can be specified as object specs | |
| * for use with ObjectFactory, using an array, a plain class name, | |
| * or a callback. | |
| * | |
| * @note The constructor signature of job classes has to follow one of two patterns: | |
| * Either it takes a parameter array as the first argument, followed by any services it | |
| * needs to have injected: ( array $params, ... ). | |
| * Or it takes a PageReference as the first parameter, followed by the parameter array, | |
| * followed by any services: ( PageReference $page, array $params, ... ). | |
| * In order to signal to the JobFactory that the $page parameter should be omitted from | |
| * the constructor arguments, the job class has to be a subclass of GenericParameterJob, | |
| * or the object specification for the job has to set the 'needsPage' key to false. | |
| * If a callback is used, its signature follows the same rules. | |
| */ | |
| public const JobClasses = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'deletePage' => DeletePageJob::class, | |
| 'refreshLinks' => RefreshLinksJob::class, | |
| 'deleteLinks' => DeleteLinksJob::class, | |
| 'htmlCacheUpdate' => HTMLCacheUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'sendMail' => [ | |
| 'class' => EmaillingJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 0 => 'Emailer' | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'enotifNotify' => [ | |
| 'class' => RecentChangeNotifyJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'RecentChangeLookup', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'fixDoubleRedirect' => [ | |
| 'class' => DoubleRedirectJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'RevisionLookup', | |
| 'MagicWordFactory', | |
| 'WikiPageFactory', | |
| ], | |
| // This job requires a title | |
| 'needsPage' => true, | |
| ], | |
| 'AssembleUploadChunks' => AssembleUploadChunksJob::class, | |
| 'PublishStashedFile' => PublishStashedFileJob::class, | |
| 'ThumbnailRender' => ThumbnailRenderJob::class, | |
| 'UploadFromUrl' => UploadFromUrlJob::class, | |
| 'recentChangesUpdate' => RecentChangesUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'refreshLinksPrioritized' => RefreshLinksJob::class, | |
| 'refreshLinksDynamic' => RefreshLinksJob::class, | |
| 'activityUpdateJob' => ActivityUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'categoryMembershipChange' => [ | |
| 'class' => CategoryMembershipChangeJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'RecentChangeFactory', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'CategoryCountUpdateJob' => [ | |
| 'class' => CategoryCountUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'ConnectionProvider', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'clearUserWatchlist' => ClearUserWatchlistJob::class, | |
| 'watchlistExpiry' => WatchlistExpiryJob::class, | |
| 'cdnPurge' => CdnPurgeJob::class, | |
| 'userGroupExpiry' => UserGroupExpiryJob::class, | |
| 'clearWatchlistNotifications' => ClearWatchlistNotificationsJob::class, | |
| 'userOptionsUpdate' => UserOptionsUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'revertedTagUpdate' => RevertedTagUpdateJob::class, | |
| 'null' => NullJob::class, | |
| 'userEditCountInit' => UserEditCountInitJob::class, | |
| 'parsoidCachePrewarm' => [ | |
| 'class' => ParsoidCachePrewarmJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'ParserOutputAccess', | |
| 'PageStore', | |
| 'RevisionLookup', | |
| 'ParsoidSiteConfig', | |
| ], | |
| // tell the JobFactory not to include the $page parameter in the constructor call | |
| 'needsPage' => false | |
| ], | |
| 'renameUserTable' => [ | |
| 'class' => RenameUserTableJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory' | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'renameUserDerived' => [ | |
| 'class' => RenameUserDerivedJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'RenameUserFactory', | |
| 'UserFactory' | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| // 'renameUser' is a alias for backward compatibility | |
| // it should be removed in the future releases | |
| 'renameUser' => [ | |
| 'class' => RenameUserTableJob::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'MainConfig', | |
| 'DBLoadBalancerFactory' | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Jobs that must be explicitly requested, i.e. aren't run by job runners unless | |
| * special flags are set. The values here are keys of $wgJobClasses. | |
| * | |
| * These can be: | |
| * - Very long-running jobs. | |
| * - Jobs that you would never want to run as part of a page rendering request. | |
| * - Jobs that you want to run on specialized machines ( like transcoding, or a particular | |
| * machine on your cluster has 'outside' web access you could restrict uploadFromUrl ) | |
| * These settings should be global to all wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const JobTypesExcludedFromDefaultQueue = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'AssembleUploadChunks', 'PublishStashedFile', 'UploadFromUrl' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map of job types to how many job "work items" should be run per second | |
| * on each job runner process. The meaning of "work items" varies per job, | |
| * but typically would be something like "pages to update". A single job | |
| * may have a variable number of work items, as is the case with batch jobs. | |
| * | |
| * This is used by runJobs.php and not jobs run via $wgJobRunRate. | |
| * These settings should be global to all wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const JobBackoffThrottling = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'float', ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Map of job types to configuration arrays. | |
| * | |
| * This determines which queue class and storage system is used for each job type. | |
| * Job types that do not have explicit configuration will use the 'default' config. | |
| * These settings should be global to all wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const JobTypeConf = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'class' => JobQueueDB::class, | |
| 'order' => 'random', | |
| 'claimTTL' => 3600 | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'object', | |
| 'properties' => [ | |
| 'class' => [ 'type' => 'string' ], | |
| 'order' => [ 'type' => 'string' ], | |
| 'claimTTL' => [ 'type' => 'int' ] | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to include the number of jobs that are queued | |
| * for the API's maxlag parameter. | |
| * | |
| * The total number of jobs will be divided by this to get an | |
| * estimated second of maxlag. Typically bots backoff at maxlag=5, | |
| * so setting this to the max number of jobs that should be in your | |
| * queue divided by 5 should have the effect of stopping bots once | |
| * that limit is hit. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.29 | |
| */ | |
| public const JobQueueIncludeInMaxLagFactor = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional functions to be performed with updateSpecialPages. | |
| * | |
| * Expensive Querypages are already updated. | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialPageCacheUpdates = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'Statistics' => [ SiteStatsUpdate::class, 'cacheUpdate' ] | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Page property link table invalidation lists. When a page property | |
| * changes, this may require other link tables to be updated (eg | |
| * adding __HIDDENCAT__ means the hiddencat tracking category will | |
| * have been added, so the categorylinks table needs to be rebuilt). | |
| * | |
| * This array can be added to by extensions. | |
| */ | |
| public const PagePropLinkInvalidations = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'hiddencat' => 'categorylinks', ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End extensions | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Categories | |
| /** @name Categories */ | |
| /** | |
| * On category pages, show thumbnail gallery for images belonging to that | |
| * category instead of listing them as articles. | |
| */ | |
| public const CategoryMagicGallery = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Paging limit for categories | |
| */ | |
| public const CategoryPagingLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => 200, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Specify how category names should be sorted, when listed on a category page. | |
| * | |
| * A sorting scheme is also known as a collation. | |
| * | |
| * Available values are: | |
| * | |
| * - uppercase: Converts the category name to upper case, and sorts by that. | |
| * | |
| * - identity: Does no conversion. Sorts by binary value of the string. | |
| * | |
| * - uca-default: Provides access to the Unicode Collation Algorithm with | |
| * the default element table. This is a compromise collation which sorts | |
| * all languages in a mediocre way. However, it is better than "uppercase". | |
| * | |
| * To use the uca-default collation, you must have PHP's intl extension | |
| * installed. See https://www.php.net/manual/en/intl.setup.php . The details of the | |
| * resulting collation will depend on the version of ICU installed on the | |
| * server. | |
| * | |
| * After you change this, you must run maintenance/updateCollation.php to fix | |
| * the sort keys in the database. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions can define there own collations by subclassing Collation | |
| * and using the Collation::factory hook. | |
| */ | |
| public const CategoryCollation = [ | |
| 'default' => 'uppercase', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional category collations to store during LinksUpdate. This can be used | |
| * to perform online migration of categories from one collation to another. An | |
| * array of associative arrays each having the following keys: | |
| * | |
| * - table: (string) The table name | |
| * - collation: (string) The collation to use for cl_sortkey | |
| * - fakeCollation: (string) The collation name to insert into cl_collation | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const TempCategoryCollations = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to sort categories in OutputPage for display. | |
| * | |
| * The value of CategoryCollation is used for sorting. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL This feature is used for Parsoid development, | |
| * but its future as a core feature will depend on community uptake. | |
| */ | |
| public const SortedCategories = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Array holding default tracking category names. | |
| * | |
| * Array contains the system messages for each tracking category. | |
| * Tracking categories allow pages with certain characteristics to be tracked. | |
| * It works by adding any such page to a category automatically. | |
| * | |
| * A message with the suffix '-desc' should be added as a description message | |
| * to have extra information on Special:TrackingCategories. | |
| * | |
| * @deprecated since 1.25 Extensions should now register tracking categories using | |
| * the new extension registration system. | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const TrackingCategories = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.25 Extensions should now register tracking categories using ' . | |
| 'the new extension registration system.', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End categories | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Logging | |
| /** @name Logging */ | |
| /** | |
| * The logging system has two levels: an event type, which describes the | |
| * general category and can be viewed as a named subset of all logs; and | |
| * an action, which is a specific kind of event that can exist in that | |
| * log type. | |
| * | |
| * Note that code should call LogPage::validTypes() to get a list of valid | |
| * log types instead of checking the global variable. | |
| */ | |
| public const LogTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| '', | |
| 'block', | |
| 'protect', | |
| 'rights', | |
| 'delete', | |
| 'upload', | |
| 'move', | |
| 'import', | |
| 'interwiki', | |
| 'patrol', | |
| 'merge', | |
| 'suppress', | |
| 'tag', | |
| 'managetags', | |
| 'contentmodel', | |
| 'renameuser', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * This restricts log access to those who have a certain right | |
| * Users without this will not see it in the option menu and can not view it | |
| * Restricted logs are not added to recent changes | |
| * Logs should remain non-transcludable | |
| * Format: logtype => permissiontype | |
| */ | |
| public const LogRestrictions = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'suppress' => 'suppressionlog', ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Show/hide links on Special:Log will be shown for these log types. | |
| * | |
| * This is associative array of log type => boolean "hide by default" | |
| * | |
| * See $wgLogTypes for a list of available log types. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * `$wgFilterLogTypes = [ 'move' => true, 'import' => false ];` | |
| * | |
| * Will display show/hide links for the move and import logs. Move logs will be | |
| * hidden by default unless the link is clicked. Import logs will be shown by | |
| * default, and hidden when the link is clicked. | |
| * | |
| * A message of the form logeventslist-[type]-log should be added, and will be | |
| * used for the link text. | |
| */ | |
| public const FilterLogTypes = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'patrol' => true, | |
| 'tag' => true, | |
| 'newusers' => false, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Lists the message key string for each log type. The localized messages | |
| * will be listed in the user interface. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions with custom log types may add to this array. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.19, if you follow the naming convention log-name-TYPE, | |
| * where TYPE is your log type, you don't need to use this array. | |
| */ | |
| public const LogNames = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| '' => 'all-logs-page', | |
| 'block' => 'blocklogpage', | |
| 'protect' => 'protectlogpage', | |
| 'rights' => 'rightslog', | |
| 'delete' => 'dellogpage', | |
| 'upload' => 'uploadlogpage', | |
| 'move' => 'movelogpage', | |
| 'import' => 'importlogpage', | |
| 'patrol' => 'patrol-log-page', | |
| 'merge' => 'mergelog', | |
| 'suppress' => 'suppressionlog', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Lists the message key string for descriptive text to be shown at the | |
| * top of each log type. | |
| * | |
| * Extensions with custom log types may add to this array. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.19, if you follow the naming convention log-description-TYPE, | |
| * where TYPE is your log type, yoy don't need to use this array. | |
| */ | |
| public const LogHeaders = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| '' => 'alllogstext', | |
| 'block' => 'blocklogtext', | |
| 'delete' => 'dellogpagetext', | |
| 'import' => 'importlogpagetext', | |
| 'merge' => 'mergelogpagetext', | |
| 'move' => 'movelogpagetext', | |
| 'patrol' => 'patrol-log-header', | |
| 'protect' => 'protectlogtext', | |
| 'rights' => 'rightslogtext', | |
| 'suppress' => 'suppressionlogtext', | |
| 'upload' => 'uploadlogpagetext', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maps log actions to message keys, for formatting log entries of each type | |
| * and action when displaying logs to the user. | |
| * The array keys are composed as "$type/$action". | |
| * | |
| * Extensions with custom log types may add to this array. | |
| */ | |
| public const LogActions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The same as above, but here values are class names or ObjectFactory specifications, | |
| * not messages. The specification must resolve to a LogFormatter subclass, | |
| * and will receive the LogEntry object as its first constructor argument. | |
| * The type can be specified as '*' (e.g. 'block/*') to handle all types. | |
| * | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Logging\LogPage::actionText | |
| * @see \MediaWiki\Logging\LogFormatter | |
| */ | |
| public const LogActionsHandlers = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'block/block' => [ | |
| 'class' => BlockLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'block/reblock' => [ | |
| 'class' => BlockLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'block/unblock' => [ | |
| 'class' => BlockLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'contentmodel/change' => ContentModelLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'contentmodel/new' => ContentModelLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/delete' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/delete_redir' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/delete_redir2' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/event' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/restore' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'delete/revision' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'import/interwiki' => ImportLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'import/upload' => ImportLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'interwiki/iw_add' => InterwikiLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'interwiki/iw_delete' => InterwikiLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'interwiki/iw_edit' => InterwikiLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'managetags/activate' => LogFormatter::class, | |
| 'managetags/create' => LogFormatter::class, | |
| 'managetags/deactivate' => LogFormatter::class, | |
| 'managetags/delete' => LogFormatter::class, | |
| 'merge/merge' => [ | |
| 'class' => MergeLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'merge/merge-into' => [ | |
| 'class' => MergeLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'move/move' => [ | |
| 'class' => MoveLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'move/move_redir' => [ | |
| 'class' => MoveLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'patrol/patrol' => PatrolLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'patrol/autopatrol' => PatrolLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'protect/modify' => [ | |
| 'class' => ProtectLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'protect/move_prot' => [ | |
| 'class' => ProtectLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'protect/protect' => [ | |
| 'class' => ProtectLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'protect/unprotect' => [ | |
| 'class' => ProtectLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'renameuser/renameuser' => [ | |
| 'class' => RenameuserLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'rights/autopromote' => RightsLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'rights/rights' => RightsLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'suppress/block' => [ | |
| 'class' => BlockLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'suppress/delete' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'suppress/event' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'suppress/reblock' => [ | |
| 'class' => BlockLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'services' => [ | |
| 'TitleParser', | |
| 'NamespaceInfo', | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'suppress/revision' => DeleteLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'tag/update' => TagLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'upload/overwrite' => UploadLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'upload/revert' => UploadLogFormatter::class, | |
| 'upload/upload' => UploadLogFormatter::class, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of log types that can be filtered by action types | |
| * | |
| * To each action is associated the list of log_action | |
| * subtypes to search for, usually one, but not necessarily so | |
| * Extensions may append to this array | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const ActionFilteredLogs = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'block' => [ | |
| 'block' => [ 'block' ], | |
| 'reblock' => [ 'reblock' ], | |
| 'unblock' => [ 'unblock' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'contentmodel' => [ | |
| 'change' => [ 'change' ], | |
| 'new' => [ 'new' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'delete' => [ | |
| 'delete' => [ 'delete' ], | |
| 'delete_redir' => [ 'delete_redir', 'delete_redir2' ], | |
| 'restore' => [ 'restore' ], | |
| 'event' => [ 'event' ], | |
| 'revision' => [ 'revision' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'import' => [ | |
| 'interwiki' => [ 'interwiki' ], | |
| 'upload' => [ 'upload' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'managetags' => [ | |
| 'create' => [ 'create' ], | |
| 'delete' => [ 'delete' ], | |
| 'activate' => [ 'activate' ], | |
| 'deactivate' => [ 'deactivate' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'move' => [ | |
| 'move' => [ 'move' ], | |
| 'move_redir' => [ 'move_redir' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'newusers' => [ | |
| 'create' => [ 'create', 'newusers' ], | |
| 'create2' => [ 'create2' ], | |
| 'autocreate' => [ 'autocreate' ], | |
| 'byemail' => [ 'byemail' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'protect' => [ | |
| 'protect' => [ 'protect' ], | |
| 'modify' => [ 'modify' ], | |
| 'unprotect' => [ 'unprotect' ], | |
| 'move_prot' => [ 'move_prot' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'rights' => [ | |
| 'rights' => [ 'rights' ], | |
| 'autopromote' => [ 'autopromote' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'suppress' => [ | |
| 'event' => [ 'event' ], | |
| 'revision' => [ 'revision' ], | |
| 'delete' => [ 'delete' ], | |
| 'block' => [ 'block' ], | |
| 'reblock' => [ 'reblock' ], | |
| ], | |
| 'upload' => [ | |
| 'upload' => [ 'upload' ], | |
| 'overwrite' => [ 'overwrite' ], | |
| 'revert' => [ 'revert' ], | |
| ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maintain a log of newusers at Special:Log/newusers? | |
| */ | |
| public const NewUserLog = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maintain a log of page creations at Special:Log/create? | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.32 | |
| */ | |
| public const PageCreationLog = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end logging | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Special pages (general and miscellaneous) | |
| /** @name Special pages (general and miscellaneous) */ | |
| /** | |
| * Allow special page inclusions such as {{Special:Allpages}} | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowSpecialInclusion = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set this to an array of special page names to prevent | |
| * maintenance/updateSpecialPages.php from updating those pages. | |
| * | |
| * Mapping each special page name to a run mode like 'periodical' if a cronjob is set up. | |
| */ | |
| public const DisableQueryPageUpdate = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * On Special:Unusedimages, consider images "used", if they are put | |
| * into a category. Default (false) is not to count those as used. | |
| */ | |
| public const CountCategorizedImagesAsUsed = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum number of links to a redirect page listed on | |
| * Special:Whatlinkshere/RedirectDestination | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxRedirectLinksRetrieved = [ | |
| 'default' => 500, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shortest CIDR limits that can be checked in any individual range check | |
| * at Special:Contributions. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.30 | |
| */ | |
| public const RangeContributionsCIDRLimit = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'IPv4' => 16, | |
| 'IPv6' => 32, | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ 'type' => 'integer', ], | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end special pages | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Actions | |
| /** @name Actions */ | |
| /** | |
| * Map of allowed values for the "title=foo&action=<action>" parameter. | |
| * to the corresponding handler code. | |
| * See ActionFactory for the syntax. Core defaults are in ActionFactory::CORE_ACTIONS, | |
| * anything here overrides that. | |
| */ | |
| public const Actions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end actions | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Robot (search engine crawler) policy | |
| /** @name Robot (search engine crawler) policy */ | |
| // See also $wgNoFollowLinks. | |
| /** | |
| * Default robot policy. The default policy is to encourage indexing and fol- | |
| * lowing of links. It may be overridden on a per-namespace and/or per-page | |
| * basis. | |
| */ | |
| public const DefaultRobotPolicy = [ | |
| 'default' => 'index,follow', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Robot policies per namespaces. The default policy is given above, the array | |
| * is made of namespace constants as defined in includes/Defines.php. You can- | |
| * not specify a different default policy for NS_SPECIAL: it is always noindex, | |
| * nofollow. This is because a number of special pages (e.g., ListPages) have | |
| * many permutations of options that display the same data under redundant | |
| * URLs, so search engine spiders risk getting lost in a maze of twisty special | |
| * pages, all alike, and never reaching your actual content. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgNamespaceRobotPolicies = [ NS_TALK => 'noindex' ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const NamespaceRobotPolicies = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Robot policies per article. These override the per-namespace robot policies. | |
| * | |
| * Must be in the form of an array where the key part is a properly canonicalised | |
| * text form title and the value is a robot policy. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgArticleRobotPolicies = [ | |
| * 'Main Page' => 'noindex,follow', | |
| * 'User:Bob' => 'index,follow', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * | |
| * **Example that DOES NOT WORK because the names are not canonical text** | |
| * forms: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgArticleRobotPolicies = [ | |
| * // Underscore, not space! | |
| * 'Main_Page' => 'noindex,follow', | |
| * // "Project", not the actual project name! | |
| * 'Project:X' => 'index,follow', | |
| * // Needs to be "Abc", not "abc" (unless $wgCapitalLinks is false for that namespace)! | |
| * 'abc' => 'noindex,nofollow' | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ArticleRobotPolicies = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * An array of namespace keys in which the __INDEX__/__NOINDEX__ magic words | |
| * will not function, so users can't decide whether pages in that namespace are | |
| * indexed by search engines. If set to null, default to $wgContentNamespaces. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgExemptFromUserRobotsControl = [ NS_MAIN, NS_TALK, NS_PROJECT ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const ExemptFromUserRobotsControl = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?list', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion End robot policy | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Action API and REST API | |
| /** @name Action API and REST API | |
| */ | |
| /** | |
| * WARNING: SECURITY THREAT - debug use only | |
| * | |
| * Disables many security checks in the API for debugging purposes. | |
| * This flag should never be used on the production servers, as it introduces | |
| * a number of potential security holes. Even when enabled, the validation | |
| * will still be performed, but instead of failing, API will return a warning. | |
| * Also, there will always be a warning notifying that this flag is set. | |
| * At this point, the flag allows GET requests to go through for modules | |
| * requiring POST. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.21 | |
| */ | |
| public const DebugAPI = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * API module extensions. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping module name to modules specs; | |
| * Each module spec is an associative array containing at least | |
| * the 'class' key for the module's class, and optionally a | |
| * 'factory' key for the factory function to use for the module. | |
| * | |
| * That factory function will be called with two parameters, | |
| * the parent module (an instance of ApiBase, usually ApiMain) | |
| * and the name the module was registered under. The return | |
| * value must be an instance of the class given in the 'class' | |
| * field. | |
| * | |
| * For backward compatibility, the module spec may also be a | |
| * simple string containing the module's class name. In that | |
| * case, the class' constructor will be called with the parent | |
| * module and module name as parameters, as described above. | |
| * | |
| * Examples for registering API modules: | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgAPIModules['foo'] = 'ApiFoo'; | |
| * $wgAPIModules['bar'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => ApiBar::class, | |
| * 'factory' => function( $main, $name ) { ... } | |
| * ]; | |
| * $wgAPIModules['xyzzy'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => ApiXyzzy::class, | |
| * 'factory' => [ XyzzyFactory::class, 'newApiModule' ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| * Extension modules may override the core modules. | |
| * See ApiMain::MODULES for a list of the core modules. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * API format module extensions. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping format module name to module specs (see $wgAPIModules). | |
| * Extension modules may override the core modules. | |
| * | |
| * See ApiMain::FORMATS for a list of the core format modules. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIFormatModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * API Query meta module extensions. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping meta module name to module specs (see $wgAPIModules). | |
| * Extension modules may override the core modules. | |
| * | |
| * See ApiQuery::QUERY_META_MODULES for a list of the core meta modules. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIMetaModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * API Query prop module extensions. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping prop module name to module specs (see $wgAPIModules). | |
| * Extension modules may override the core modules. | |
| * | |
| * See ApiQuery::QUERY_PROP_MODULES for a list of the core prop modules. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIPropModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * API Query list module extensions. | |
| * | |
| * Associative array mapping list module name to module specs (see $wgAPIModules). | |
| * Extension modules may override the core modules. | |
| * | |
| * See ApiQuery::QUERY_LIST_MODULES for a list of the core list modules. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIListModules = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum amount of rows to scan in a DB query in the API | |
| * The default value is generally fine | |
| */ | |
| public const APIMaxDBRows = [ | |
| 'default' => 5000, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum size (in bytes) of an API result. | |
| * | |
| * @warning Do not set this lower than $wgMaxArticleSize*1024 | |
| */ | |
| public const APIMaxResultSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 8_388_608, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum number of uncached diffs that can be retrieved in one API | |
| * request. Set this to 0 to disable API diffs altogether | |
| */ | |
| public const APIMaxUncachedDiffs = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum amount of DB lag on a majority of DB replica DBs to tolerate | |
| * before forcing bots to retry any write requests via API errors. | |
| * | |
| * This should be lower than the 'max lag' value in $wgLBFactoryConf. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIMaxLagThreshold = [ | |
| 'default' => 7, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Log file or URL (TCP or UDP) to log API requests to, or false to disable | |
| * API request logging | |
| */ | |
| public const APIRequestLog = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'deprecated' => 'since 1.43; use api or api-request $wgDebugLogGroups channel', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Set the timeout for the API help text cache. If set to 0, caching disabled | |
| */ | |
| public const APICacheHelpTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 60 * 60, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The ApiQueryQueryPages module should skip pages that are redundant to true | |
| * API queries. | |
| */ | |
| public const APIUselessQueryPages = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'MIMEsearch', | |
| 'LinkSearch', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Enable previewing licences via AJAX. | |
| */ | |
| public const AjaxLicensePreview = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Settings for incoming cross-site AJAX requests: | |
| * Newer browsers support cross-site AJAX when the target resource allows requests | |
| * from the origin domain by the Access-Control-Allow-Origin header. | |
| * | |
| * This is currently only used by the API (requests to api.php) | |
| * $wgCrossSiteAJAXdomains can be set using a wildcard syntax: | |
| * | |
| * - '*' matches any number of characters | |
| * - '?' matches any 1 character | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * $wgCrossSiteAJAXdomains = [ | |
| * 'www.mediawiki.org', | |
| * '*.wikipedia.org', | |
| * '*.wikimedia.org', | |
| * '*.wiktionary.org', | |
| * ]; | |
| * ``` | |
| */ | |
| public const CrossSiteAJAXdomains = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Domains that should not be allowed to make AJAX requests, | |
| * even if they match one of the domains allowed by $wgCrossSiteAJAXdomains | |
| * Uses the same syntax as $wgCrossSiteAJAXdomains | |
| */ | |
| public const CrossSiteAJAXdomainExceptions = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of allowed headers for cross-origin API requests. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowedCorsHeaders = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| /* simple headers (see spec) */ | |
| 'Accept', | |
| 'Accept-Language', | |
| 'Content-Language', | |
| 'Content-Type', | |
| /* non-authorable headers in XHR, which are however requested by some UAs */ | |
| 'Accept-Encoding', | |
| 'DNT', | |
| 'Origin', | |
| /* MediaWiki whitelist */ | |
| 'User-Agent', | |
| 'Api-User-Agent', | |
| /* Allowing caching preflight requests, see T269636 */ | |
| 'Access-Control-Max-Age', | |
| /* OAuth 2.0, see T322944 */ | |
| 'Authorization', | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Additional REST API Route files. | |
| * | |
| * A common usage is to enable development/experimental endpoints only on test wikis. | |
| */ | |
| public const RestAPIAdditionalRouteFiles = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End AJAX and API | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Shell and process control | |
| /** @name Shell and process control */ | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum amount of virtual memory available to shell processes under linux, in KiB. | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxShellMemory = [ | |
| 'default' => 307_200, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum file size created by shell processes under linux, in KiB | |
| * ImageMagick convert for example can be fairly hungry for scratch space | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxShellFileSize = [ | |
| 'default' => 102_400, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum CPU time in seconds for shell processes under Linux | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxShellTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 180, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Maximum wall clock time (i.e. real time, of the kind the clock on the wall | |
| * would measure) in seconds for shell processes under Linux | |
| */ | |
| public const MaxShellWallClockTime = [ | |
| 'default' => 180, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Under Linux: a cgroup directory used to constrain memory usage of shell | |
| * commands. The directory must be writable by the user which runs MediaWiki. | |
| * | |
| * If specified, this is used instead of ulimit, which is inaccurate, and | |
| * causes malloc() to return NULL, which exposes bugs in C applications, making | |
| * them segfault or deadlock. | |
| * | |
| * A wrapper script will create a cgroup for each shell command that runs, as | |
| * a subgroup of the specified cgroup. If the memory limit is exceeded, the | |
| * kernel will send a SIGKILL signal to a process in the subgroup. | |
| * | |
| * **Example:** | |
| * | |
| * ``` | |
| * mkdir -p /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/mediawiki | |
| * mkdir -m 0777 /sys/fs/cgroup/memory/mediawiki/job | |
| * echo '$wgShellCgroup = "/sys/fs/cgroup/memory/mediawiki/job";' >> LocalSettings.php | |
| * ``` | |
| * The reliability of cgroup cleanup can be improved by installing a | |
| * notify_on_release script in the root cgroup, see e.g. | |
| * https://gerrit.wikimedia.org/r/#/c/40784 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShellCgroup = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Executable path of the PHP cli binary. Should be set up on install. | |
| */ | |
| public const PhpCli = [ | |
| 'default' => '/usr/bin/php', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Method to use to restrict shell commands | |
| * | |
| * Supported options: | |
| * - 'autodetect': Autodetect if any restriction methods are available | |
| * - 'firejail': Use firejail <https://firejail.wordpress.com/> | |
| * - false: Don't use any restrictions | |
| * | |
| * @note If using firejail with MediaWiki running in a home directory different | |
| * from the webserver user, firejail 0.9.44+ is required. | |
| * @since 1.31 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShellRestrictionMethod = [ | |
| 'default' => 'autodetect', | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Shell commands can be run on a remote server using Shellbox. To use this | |
| * feature, set this to the URLs mapped by the service, and also configure $wgShellboxSecretKey. | |
| * | |
| * You can also disable a certain service by setting it to false or null. | |
| * | |
| * 'default' would be the default URL if no URL is defined for that service. | |
| * | |
| * For more information about installing Shellbox, see | |
| * https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Shellbox | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.37 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShellboxUrls = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'default' => null, ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| 'additionalProperties' => [ | |
| 'type' => 'string|false|null', | |
| ], | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The secret key for HMAC verification of Shellbox requests. Set this to | |
| * a long random string. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.36 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShellboxSecretKey = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The POSIX-compatible shell to use when running scripts. This is used by | |
| * some media handling shell commands. | |
| * | |
| * If ShellboxUrls is configured, this path should exist on the remote side. | |
| * On Windows this should be the full path to bash.exe, not git-bash.exe. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShellboxShell = [ | |
| 'default' => '/bin/sh', | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- end Shell and process control | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region HTTP client | |
| /** @name HTTP client */ | |
| /** | |
| * Timeout for HTTP requests done internally, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.5 | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 25, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Timeout for connections done internally (in seconds). | |
| * | |
| * Only supported if cURL is installed, ignored otherwise. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.22 | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPConnectTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 5.0, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum HTTP request timeout in seconds. If any specified or configured | |
| * request timeout is larger than this, then this value will be used instead. | |
| * Zero is interpreted as "no limit". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPMaxTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * The maximum HTTP connect timeout in seconds. If any specified or configured | |
| * connect timeout is larger than this, then this value will be used instead. | |
| * Zero is interpreted as "no limit". | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.35 | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPMaxConnectTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 0, | |
| 'type' => 'float', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Timeout for HTTP requests done internally for transwiki imports, in seconds. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.29 | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPImportTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 25, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Timeout for Asynchronous (background) HTTP requests, in seconds. | |
| */ | |
| public const AsyncHTTPTimeout = [ | |
| 'default' => 25, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Proxy to use for CURL requests. | |
| */ | |
| public const HTTPProxy = [ | |
| 'default' => '', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * A list of URL domains that will be routed to the proxy specified by | |
| * $wgLocalHTTPProxy. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalVirtualHosts = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Proxy to use for requests to domains in $wgLocalVirtualHosts | |
| * | |
| * If set to false, no reverse proxy will be used for local requests. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const LocalHTTPProxy = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'string|false', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to respect/honour | |
| * - request ID provided by the incoming request via the `X-Request-Id` | |
| * - trace context provided by the incoming request via the `tracestate` and `traceparent` | |
| * | |
| * Set to `true` if the entity sitting in front of MediaWiki sanitises external requests. | |
| * | |
| * Default: `false`. | |
| */ | |
| public const AllowExternalReqID = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End HTTP client | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Job queue | |
| /** @name Job queue */ | |
| /** | |
| * Number of jobs to perform per request. May be less than one in which case jobs are | |
| * performed probabilistically. If this is zero, jobs will not be done during ordinary | |
| * apache requests. In this case, maintenance/runJobs.php should be run in loop every | |
| * few seconds via a service or cron job. If using a cron job, be sure to handle the | |
| * case where the script is already running (e.g. via `/usr/bin/flock -n <lock_file>`). | |
| * | |
| * If this is set to a non-zero number, then it is highly recommended that PHP run in | |
| * fastcgi mode (php_fpm). When using a standard Apache PHP handler (mod_php), it is | |
| * recommended that output_buffering and zlib.output_compression both be set to "Off", | |
| * allowing MediaWiki to install an unlimited size output buffer on the fly. Setting | |
| * output_buffering to an integer (e.g. 4096) or enabling zlib.output_compression can | |
| * cause user-visible slowness as background tasks execute during web requests. | |
| * | |
| * Regardless of the web server engine in use, be sure to configure a sufficient number | |
| * processes/threads in order to avoid exhaustion (which will cause user-visible slowness). | |
| */ | |
| public const JobRunRate = [ | |
| 'default' => 1, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * When $wgJobRunRate > 0, try to run jobs asynchronously, spawning a new process | |
| * to handle the job execution, instead of blocking the request until the job | |
| * execution finishes. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.23 | |
| */ | |
| public const RunJobsAsync = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of rows to update per job | |
| */ | |
| public const UpdateRowsPerJob = [ | |
| 'default' => 300, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of rows to update per query | |
| */ | |
| public const UpdateRowsPerQuery = [ | |
| 'default' => 100, | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End job queue | |
| /***************************************************************************/ | |
| // region Miscellaneous | |
| /** @name Miscellaneous */ | |
| /** | |
| * Allow redirection to another page when a user logs in. | |
| * | |
| * To enable, set to a string like 'Main Page' | |
| */ | |
| public const RedirectOnLogin = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Global configuration variable for Virtual REST Services. | |
| * | |
| * Use the 'path' key to define automatically mounted services. The value for this | |
| * key is a map of path prefixes to service configuration. The latter is an array of: | |
| * - class : the fully qualified class name | |
| * - options : map of arguments to the class constructor | |
| * Such services will be available to handle queries under their path from the VRS | |
| * singleton, e.g. MediaWikiServices::getInstance()->getVirtualRESTServiceClient(); | |
| * | |
| * Auto-mounting example for Parsoid: | |
| * | |
| * $wgVirtualRestConfig['paths']['/parsoid/'] = [ | |
| * 'class' => ParsoidVirtualRESTService::class, | |
| * 'options' => [ | |
| * 'url' => 'http://localhost:8000', | |
| * 'prefix' => 'enwiki', | |
| * 'domain' => 'en.wikipedia.org' | |
| * ] | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * Parameters for different services can also be declared inside the 'modules' value, | |
| * which is to be treated as an associative array. The parameters in 'global' will be | |
| * merged with service-specific ones. The result will then be passed to | |
| * VirtualRESTService::__construct() in the module. | |
| * | |
| * Example config for Parsoid: | |
| * | |
| * $wgVirtualRestConfig['modules']['parsoid'] = [ | |
| * 'url' => 'http://localhost:8000', | |
| * 'prefix' => 'enwiki', | |
| * 'domain' => 'en.wikipedia.org', | |
| * ]; | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.25 | |
| */ | |
| public const VirtualRestConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'paths' => [], | |
| 'modules' => [], | |
| 'global' => [ | |
| # Timeout in seconds | |
| 'timeout' => 360, | |
| # 'domain' is set to $wgCanonicalServer in Setup.php | |
| 'forwardCookies' => false, | |
| 'HTTPProxy' => null | |
| ] | |
| ], | |
| 'mergeStrategy' => 'array_plus_2d', | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Mapping of event channels (or channel categories) to EventRelayer configuration. | |
| * | |
| * By setting up a PubSub system (like Kafka) and enabling a corresponding EventRelayer class | |
| * that uses it, MediaWiki can broadcast events to all subscribers. Certain features like WAN | |
| * cache purging and CDN cache purging will emit events to this system. Appropriate listeners | |
| * can subscribe to the channel and take actions based on the events. For example, a local daemon | |
| * can run on each CDN cache node and perform local purges based on the URL purge channel | |
| * events. | |
| * | |
| * Some extensions may want to use "channel categories" so that different channels can also | |
| * share the same custom relayer instance (e.g. when it's likely to be overridden). They can use | |
| * EventRelayerGroup::getRelayer() based on the category but call notify() on various different | |
| * actual channels. One reason for this would be that some systems have very different | |
| * performance vs durability needs, so one system (e.g. Kafka) may not be suitable for all | |
| * uses. | |
| * | |
| * The 'default' key is for all channels (or channel categories) without an explicit entry | |
| * here. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.27 | |
| */ | |
| public const EventRelayerConfig = [ | |
| 'default' => [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'class' => EventRelayerNull::class, ], | |
| ], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Share data about this installation with MediaWiki developers | |
| * | |
| * When set to true, MediaWiki will periodically ping https://www.mediawiki.org/ with basic | |
| * data about this MediaWiki instance. This data includes, for example, the type of system, | |
| * PHP version, and chosen database backend. The Wikimedia Foundation shares this data with | |
| * MediaWiki developers to help guide future development efforts. | |
| * | |
| * For details about what data is sent, see: https://www.mediawiki.org/wiki/Manual:$wgPingback | |
| * | |
| * For the pingback privacy policy, see: | |
| * https://wikimediafoundation.org/wiki/MediaWiki_Pingback_Privacy_Statement | |
| * | |
| * Aggregate pingback data is available at: https://pingback.wmcloud.org/ | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.28 | |
| */ | |
| public const Pingback = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Origin Trials tokens. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.33 | |
| */ | |
| public const OriginTrials = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Expiry of the endpoint definition for the Reporting API. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const ReportToExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 86400, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of endpoints for the Reporting API. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const ReportToEndpoints = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of Feature Policy Reporting types to enable. | |
| * | |
| * Each entry is turned into a Feature-Policy-Report-Only header. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.34 | |
| */ | |
| public const FeaturePolicyReportOnly = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of preferred skins to be listed higher in Special:Preferences | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.38 | |
| */ | |
| public const SkinsPreferred = [ | |
| 'default' => [ 'vector-2022', 'vector' ], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * List of skins that show a link to the Special:Contribute page | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.40 | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialContributeSkinsEnabled = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow redirection to another page when a user selects New Page on Special:Contribute page | |
| * | |
| */ | |
| public const SpecialContributeNewPageTarget = [ | |
| 'default' => null, | |
| 'type' => '?string', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to enable the client-side edit recovery feature. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable Temporary feature flag, T341844 | |
| * @since 1.41 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableEditRecovery = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Number of seconds to keep edit recovery data after the edit is stored. | |
| */ | |
| public const EditRecoveryExpiry = [ | |
| 'default' => 30 * 24 * 3600, | |
| 'type' => 'integer', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to use Codex in Special:Block form. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable Temporary feature flag, T358153 | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseCodexSpecialBlock = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to display a confirmation screen during user log out. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable Temporary feature flag, T357484 | |
| * @since 1.42 | |
| */ | |
| public const ShowLogoutConfirmation = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether to show indicators on a page when it is protected. | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const EnableProtectionIndicators = [ | |
| 'default' => true, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * OutputPipelineStages to add to the DefaultOutputPipeline. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable EXPERIMENTAL | |
| * @since 1.43 | |
| */ | |
| public const OutputPipelineStages = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'map', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Allow temporarily disabling use of certain features. Useful for | |
| * large site operators to push people to newer APIs while still | |
| * keeping the breakage short and contained. | |
| * | |
| * This should be an array, where a key is a feature name and the value | |
| * is an array of shutdown arrays, each containing the following keys: | |
| * 'start' => Shutdown start, parsed with strtotime(). (required) | |
| * 'end' => Shutdown end, parsed with strtotime(). (required) | |
| * 'percentage' => Number between 0 and 100. If set, only a certain | |
| * percentage of requests will be blocked. | |
| * | |
| * For example: | |
| * @code | |
| * $wgFeatureShutdown = [ | |
| * 'pre-1.24-tokens' => [ | |
| * [ | |
| * 'start' => '2021-07-01T00:00 +00:00', | |
| * 'end' => '2021-08-01T00:00 +00:00', | |
| * 'percentage' => 50, | |
| * ], | |
| * ], | |
| * ]; | |
| * @encdode | |
| * | |
| * @since 1.44 | |
| */ | |
| public const FeatureShutdown = [ | |
| 'default' => [], | |
| 'type' => 'list', | |
| ]; | |
| /** | |
| * Whether parser functions should use Leximorph handlers instead of Language methods. | |
| * | |
| * @unstable Temporary feature flag, T389281 | |
| * @since 1.45 | |
| */ | |
| public const UseLeximorph = [ | |
| 'default' => false, | |
| 'type' => 'boolean', | |
| ]; | |
| // endregion -- End Miscellaneous | |
| } |
US